* breakpoint.c (allocate_bp_location): Use bp_loc_other for
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
132 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
134 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
136 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
138 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
140 static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
142 static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
144 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
146 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
148 typedef enum
149 {
150 mark_inserted,
151 mark_uninserted
152 }
153 insertion_state_t;
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
162 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
164 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
166 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
170 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
176 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
178 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
182 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
184 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
190 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
191 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
192
193 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
194
195 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
196
197 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
198 CORE_ADDR pc);
199
200 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
201
202 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
203
204 static void update_global_location_list (int);
205
206 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
207
208 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
209
210 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
211
212 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
213
214 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
215
216 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
217
218 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
222 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
223
224 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
225
226
227 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
228 current breakpoint. */
229
230 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
231
232 static const char *
233 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
234 {
235 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
236 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
237 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
238 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
239 }
240
241 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
242 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
243 if such is available. */
244 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
245
246 static void
247 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
248 struct cmd_list_element *c,
249 const char *value)
250 {
251 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
252 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
253 value);
254 }
255
256 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
257 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
258 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
259 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
260 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
261 static void
262 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
263 struct cmd_list_element *c,
264 const char *value)
265 {
266 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
267 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
268 value);
269 }
270
271 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
272 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
273 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
274 use hardware breakpoints. */
275 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
276 static void
277 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
278 struct cmd_list_element *c,
279 const char *value)
280 {
281 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
282 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
283 value);
284 }
285
286 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
287 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
288 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
289 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
290 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
291
292 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
293 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
294 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
295 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
296 always_inserted_auto,
297 always_inserted_off,
298 always_inserted_on,
299 NULL
300 };
301 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
302 static void
303 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
304 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
305 {
306 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
307 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
308 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
309 value,
310 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
311 else
312 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
313 }
314
315 int
316 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
317 {
318 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
319 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
320 }
321
322 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
323
324 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
325 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
326
327 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
328 static int overlay_events_enabled;
329
330 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
331 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
332 breakpoint. */
333
334 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
335
336 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
337 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
338 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
339 B = TMP)
340
341 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
342 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
343 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
344
345 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
346 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
347 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
348 BP_TMP++)
349
350 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
351
352 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
353 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
354 if (tracepoint_type (B))
355
356 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
357
358 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
359
360 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
361
362 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
363
364 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
365
366 static unsigned bp_location_count;
367
368 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
369 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
370 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
371 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
372
373 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
374
375 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
376 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
377 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
378 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
379 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
380
381 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
382
383 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
384 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
385 may still be reported by a target. */
386 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
387
388 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
389
390 int breakpoint_count;
391
392 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
393
394 int tracepoint_count;
395
396 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
397 static int
398 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
399 {
400 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
401 }
402
403 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
404
405 void
406 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
407 {
408 breakpoint_count = num;
409 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
410 }
411
412 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
413
414 void
415 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
416 {
417 struct breakpoint *b;
418
419 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
420 b->hit_count = 0;
421 }
422
423 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
424
425 static int
426 tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
427 {
428 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
429 }
430
431 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
432 for "break" command with no arg.
433 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
434 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
435
436 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
437
438 int default_breakpoint_valid;
439 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
440 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
441 int default_breakpoint_line;
442 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
443
444 \f
445 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
446 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
447
448 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
449 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
450 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
451
452 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
453
454 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
455 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
456 static int
457 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
458 {
459 int retval = 0; /* default */
460 char *p = *pp;
461
462 if (p == NULL)
463 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
464 return breakpoint_count;
465 else if (*p == '$')
466 {
467 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
468 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
469 char *varname;
470 char *start = ++p;
471 LONGEST val;
472
473 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
474 p++;
475 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
476 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
477 varname[p - start] = '\0';
478 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
479 retval = (int) val;
480 else
481 {
482 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
483 retval = 0;
484 }
485 }
486 else
487 {
488 if (*p == '-')
489 ++p;
490 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
491 ++p;
492 if (p == *pp)
493 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
494 {
495 /* Skip non-numeric token */
496 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
497 ++p;
498 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
499 retval = 0;
500 }
501 else
502 retval = atoi (*pp);
503 }
504 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
505 {
506 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
507 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
508 ++p;
509 retval = 0;
510 }
511 while (isspace (*p))
512 p++;
513 *pp = p;
514 return retval;
515 }
516
517
518 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
519 int
520 get_number (char **pp)
521 {
522 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
523 }
524
525 /* Parse a number or a range.
526 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
527 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
528 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
529 * inclusive.
530 *
531 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
532 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
533 *
534 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
535 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
536 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
537 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
538 * pointer PP past <number2>.
539 */
540
541 int
542 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
543 {
544 static int last_retval, end_value;
545 static char *end_ptr;
546 static int in_range = 0;
547
548 if (**pp != '-')
549 {
550 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
551 or to the first number of a range. */
552 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
553 if (**pp == '-')
554 {
555 char **temp;
556
557 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
558 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
559 and also remember the end of the final token. */
560
561 temp = &end_ptr;
562 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
563 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
564 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
565 end_value = get_number (temp);
566 if (end_value < last_retval)
567 {
568 error (_("inverted range"));
569 }
570 else if (end_value == last_retval)
571 {
572 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
573 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
574 single number. */
575 *pp = end_ptr;
576 }
577 else
578 in_range = 1;
579 }
580 }
581 else if (! in_range)
582 error (_("negative value"));
583 else
584 {
585 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
586 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
587 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
588 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
589 is reached. */
590
591 if (++last_retval == end_value)
592 {
593 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
594 *pp = end_ptr;
595 in_range = 0;
596 }
597 }
598 return last_retval;
599 }
600
601 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
602 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
603
604 struct breakpoint *
605 get_breakpoint (int num)
606 {
607 struct breakpoint *b;
608
609 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
610 if (b->number == num)
611 return b;
612
613 return NULL;
614 }
615
616 \f
617 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
618
619 static void
620 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
621 {
622 struct breakpoint *b;
623 char *p;
624 int bnum;
625
626 if (arg == 0)
627 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
628
629 p = arg;
630 bnum = get_number (&p);
631 if (bnum == 0)
632 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
633
634 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
635 if (b->number == bnum)
636 {
637 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
638 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
639 {
640 if (loc->cond)
641 {
642 xfree (loc->cond);
643 loc->cond = 0;
644 }
645 }
646 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
647 xfree (b->cond_string);
648
649 if (*p == 0)
650 {
651 b->cond_string = NULL;
652 if (from_tty)
653 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
654 }
655 else
656 {
657 arg = p;
658 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
659 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
660 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
661 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
662 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
663 {
664 arg = p;
665 loc->cond =
666 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
667 if (*arg)
668 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
669 }
670 }
671 breakpoints_changed ();
672 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
673 return;
674 }
675
676 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
677 }
678
679 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
680
681 void
682 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
683 {
684 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
685 b->commands = commands;
686 breakpoints_changed ();
687 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
688 }
689
690 static void
691 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
692 {
693 struct breakpoint *b;
694 char *p;
695 int bnum;
696 struct command_line *l;
697
698 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
699 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
700 being read from. */
701
702 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
703 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
704
705 p = arg;
706 bnum = get_number (&p);
707
708 if (p && *p)
709 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
710
711 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
712 if (b->number == bnum)
713 {
714 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
715 bnum);
716 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
717 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
718 do_cleanups (cleanups);
719 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
720 return;
721 }
722 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
723 }
724
725 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
726 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
727
728 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
729 that are part of if and while bodies. */
730 enum command_control_type
731 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
732 {
733 struct breakpoint *b;
734 char *p;
735 int bnum;
736
737 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
738 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
739 being read from. */
740
741 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
742 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
743
744 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
745 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
746 if (arg && !*arg)
747 p = NULL;
748 else
749 p = arg;
750 bnum = get_number (&p);
751
752 if (p && *p)
753 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
754
755 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
756 if (b->number == bnum)
757 {
758 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
759 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
760 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
761 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
762 list after it finishes execution. */
763 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
764 breakpoints_changed ();
765 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
766 return simple_control;
767 }
768 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
769 }
770
771 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
772
773 static int
774 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
775 {
776 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
777 return 0;
778 if (!bl->inserted)
779 return 0;
780 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
781 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
782 return 0;
783 return 1;
784 }
785
786 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
787 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
788
789 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
790 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
791 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
792 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
793 memaddr ... memaddr + len
794 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
795 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
796 and:
797 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
798
799 void
800 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
801 {
802 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
803 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
804
805 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
806 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
807
808 bc_l = 0;
809 bc_r = bp_location_count;
810 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
811 {
812 struct bp_location *b;
813
814 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
815 b = bp_location[bc];
816
817 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
818 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
819 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
820
821 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
822 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
823 MEMADDR. */
824
825 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
826 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
827 bc_l = bc;
828 else
829 bc_r = bc;
830 }
831
832 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
833
834 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
835 {
836 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
837 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
838 int bp_size = 0;
839 int bptoffset = 0;
840
841 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
842 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
843 b->owner->number);
844
845 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
846 content. */
847
848 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
849 && memaddr + len <= b->address
850 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
851 break;
852
853 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
854 continue;
855 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
856 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
857 continue;
858
859 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
860 we need to copy. */
861 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
862 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
863
864 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
865 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
866 are reading. */
867 continue;
868
869 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
870 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
871 reading. */
872 continue;
873
874 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
875 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
876 {
877 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
878 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
879 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
880 bp_addr = memaddr;
881 }
882
883 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
884 {
885 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
886 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
887 }
888
889 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
890 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
891 }
892 }
893 \f
894
895 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
896 static void
897 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
898 {
899 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
900 int val = -1;
901
902 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
903 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
904
905 b->ops->insert (b);
906 }
907
908 static int
909 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
910 {
911 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
912 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
913 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
914 }
915
916 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
917 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
918 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
919 not need them.
920
921 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
922 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
923 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
924 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
925 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
926
927 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
928 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
929 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
930 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
931
932 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
933 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
934 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
935 chain. */
936
937 static void
938 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
939 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
940 {
941 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
942 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
943
944 *valp = NULL;
945 if (resultp)
946 *resultp = NULL;
947 if (val_chain)
948 *val_chain = NULL;
949
950 /* Evaluate the expression. */
951 mark = value_mark ();
952 result = NULL;
953
954 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
955 {
956 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
957 }
958 if (ex.reason < 0)
959 {
960 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
961 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
962 error to some higher catcher. */
963 switch (ex.error)
964 {
965 case MEMORY_ERROR:
966 break;
967 default:
968 throw_exception (ex);
969 break;
970 }
971 }
972
973 new_mark = value_mark ();
974 if (mark == new_mark)
975 return;
976 if (resultp)
977 *resultp = result;
978
979 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
980 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
981 if (result != NULL
982 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
983 *valp = result;
984
985 if (val_chain)
986 {
987 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
988 decide which addresses to watch. */
989 *val_chain = new_mark;
990 value_release_to_mark (mark);
991 }
992 }
993
994 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
995 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
996 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
997 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
998 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
999 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1000 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1001 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1002 running. */
1003
1004 static int
1005 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1006 {
1007 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1008 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1009 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1010 }
1011
1012 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1013 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1014 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1015 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1016 in b->loc->cond.
1017 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1018
1019 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1020 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1021
1022 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1023 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1024 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1025 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1026 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1027 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1028 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1029
1030 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1031 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1032 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1033 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1034 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1035 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1036 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1037 memory content has not changed.
1038
1039 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1040 watchpoints:
1041
1042 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1043 several times when GDB stops.
1044
1045 [linux]
1046 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1047 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1048 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1049 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1050 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1051 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1052 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1053 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1054 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1055 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1056
1057 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1058 removal from inferior. */
1059
1060 static void
1061 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1062 {
1063 int within_current_scope;
1064 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1065 struct bp_location *loc;
1066 int frame_saved;
1067 bpstat bs;
1068
1069 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1070 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1071 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1072 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1073 return;
1074
1075 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1076 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1077 breakpoints if needed. */
1078 b->loc = NULL;
1079
1080 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1081 return;
1082
1083 frame_saved = 0;
1084
1085 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1086 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1087 within_current_scope = 1;
1088 else
1089 {
1090 struct frame_info *fi;
1091
1092 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1093 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1094 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1095 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1096 selected frame. */
1097 frame_saved = 1;
1098 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1099
1100 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1101 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1102 if (within_current_scope)
1103 select_frame (fi);
1104 }
1105
1106 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1107 {
1108 char *s;
1109 if (b->exp)
1110 {
1111 xfree (b->exp);
1112 b->exp = NULL;
1113 }
1114 s = b->exp_string;
1115 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1116 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1117 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1118 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1119 be completely different objects. */
1120 value_free (b->val);
1121 b->val = NULL;
1122 b->val_valid = 0;
1123 }
1124
1125 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1126 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1127 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1128 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1129 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1130 if ( !target_has_execution)
1131 {
1132 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1133 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1134 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1135 }
1136 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1137 {
1138 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1139 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1140
1141 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1142
1143 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1144 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1145 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1146 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1147 if (!b->val_valid)
1148 {
1149 b->val = v;
1150 b->val_valid = 1;
1151 }
1152
1153 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1154 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1155 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1156 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1157 && reparse)
1158 {
1159 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1160
1161 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1162 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1163 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1164 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1165 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1166 watchpoint. */
1167 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1168 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1169 &other_type_used);
1170 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1171
1172 if (!mem_cnt)
1173 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1174 else
1175 {
1176 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1177 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1178 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1179 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1180 else
1181 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1182 }
1183 }
1184
1185 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1186
1187 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1188 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1189 {
1190 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1191 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1192 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1193 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1194 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1195 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1196 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1197 {
1198 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1199
1200 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1201 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1202 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1203 if (v == result
1204 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1205 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1206 {
1207 CORE_ADDR addr;
1208 int len, type;
1209 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1210
1211 addr = value_address (v);
1212 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1213 type = hw_write;
1214 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1215 type = hw_read;
1216 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1217 type = hw_access;
1218
1219 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1220 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1221 ;
1222 *tmp = loc;
1223 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1224
1225 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1226 loc->address = addr;
1227 loc->length = len;
1228 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1229 }
1230 }
1231
1232 next = value_next (v);
1233 if (v != b->val)
1234 value_free (v);
1235 }
1236
1237 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1238 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1239 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1240 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1241 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1242 {
1243 char *s = b->cond_string;
1244 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1245 }
1246 }
1247 else if (!within_current_scope)
1248 {
1249 printf_filtered (_("\
1250 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1251 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1252 b->number);
1253 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1254 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1255 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1256 }
1257
1258 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1259 if (frame_saved)
1260 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1261 }
1262
1263
1264 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1265 inserted in the inferior. */
1266 static int
1267 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1268 {
1269 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1270 return 0;
1271
1272 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1273 return 0;
1274
1275 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1276 return 0;
1277
1278 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1279 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1280 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1281 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1282 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1283 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1284 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1285 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1286 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1287 return 0;
1288
1289 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1290 not by us. */
1291 if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1292 return 0;
1293
1294 return 1;
1295 }
1296
1297 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1298 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1299 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1300
1301 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1302 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1303 static int
1304 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1305 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1306 int *disabled_breaks,
1307 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1308 {
1309 int val = 0;
1310
1311 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1312 return 0;
1313
1314 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1315 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1316 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1317 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1318
1319 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1320 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1321 {
1322 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1323 {
1324 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1325 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1326 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1327 Two important cases are:
1328 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1329 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1330 hardware breakpoint.
1331 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1332 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1333 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1334
1335 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1336 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1337 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1338 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1339 struct mem_region *mr
1340 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1341
1342 if (mr)
1343 {
1344 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1345 {
1346 int changed = 0;
1347 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1348
1349 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1350 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1351 else
1352 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1353
1354 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1355 {
1356 static int said = 0;
1357 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1358 if (!said)
1359 {
1360 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1361 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1362 said = 1;
1363 }
1364 }
1365 }
1366 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1367 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1368 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1369 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1370 }
1371 }
1372
1373 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1374 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1375 || bpt->section == NULL
1376 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1377 {
1378 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1379
1380 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1381 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1382 &bpt->target_info);
1383 else
1384 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1385 &bpt->target_info);
1386 }
1387 else
1388 {
1389 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1390 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1391 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1392 {
1393 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1394 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1395 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1396 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1397 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1398 bpt->owner->number);
1399 else
1400 {
1401 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1402 bpt->section);
1403 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1404 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1405 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1406 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1408 if (val != 0)
1409 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1410 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1411 bpt->owner->number);
1412 }
1413 }
1414 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1415 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1416 {
1417 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1418 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1419 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1420 &bpt->target_info);
1421 else
1422 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1423 &bpt->target_info);
1424 }
1425 else
1426 {
1427 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1428 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1429 return 0;
1430 }
1431 }
1432
1433 if (val)
1434 {
1435 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1436 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1437 {
1438 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1439 val = 0;
1440 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1441 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1442 {
1443 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1444 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1445 bpt->owner->number);
1446 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1447 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1448 }
1449 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1450 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1451 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1452 }
1453 else
1454 {
1455 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1456 {
1457 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1458 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1459 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1460 bpt->owner->number);
1461 }
1462 else
1463 {
1464 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1465 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1466 bpt->owner->number);
1467 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1468 "Error accessing memory address ");
1469 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1470 tmp_error_stream);
1471 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1472 safe_strerror (val));
1473 }
1474
1475 }
1476 }
1477 else
1478 bpt->inserted = 1;
1479
1480 return val;
1481 }
1482
1483 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1484 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1485 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1486 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1487 {
1488 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1489 bpt->length,
1490 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1491 bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1492 }
1493
1494 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1495 {
1496 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1497 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1498 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1499 bpt->owner->number);
1500 if (e.reason < 0)
1501 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1502 else
1503 bpt->inserted = 1;
1504
1505 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1506 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1507 so just return success. */
1508 return 0;
1509 }
1510
1511 return 0;
1512 }
1513
1514 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1515 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1516 PSPACE anymore. */
1517
1518 void
1519 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1520 {
1521 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1522 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1523
1524 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1525 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1526 {
1527 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1528 delete_breakpoint (b);
1529 }
1530
1531 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1532 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1533 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1534 {
1535 struct bp_location *tmp;
1536
1537 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1538 {
1539 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1540 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1541 else
1542 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1543 if (tmp->next == loc)
1544 {
1545 tmp->next = loc->next;
1546 break;
1547 }
1548 }
1549 }
1550
1551 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1552 removed locations above. */
1553 update_global_location_list (0);
1554 }
1555
1556 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1557 Throws exception on any error.
1558 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1559 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1560 void
1561 insert_breakpoints (void)
1562 {
1563 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1564
1565 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1566 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1567 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1568
1569 update_global_location_list (1);
1570
1571 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1572 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1573 now. */
1574 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1575 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1576 }
1577
1578 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1579 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1580 Both return zero if successful,
1581 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1582
1583 static void
1584 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1585 {
1586 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1587 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1588 int error = 0;
1589 int val = 0;
1590 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1591 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1592
1593 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1594 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1595
1596 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1597 there was an error. */
1598 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1599
1600 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1601
1602 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1603 {
1604 struct thread_info *tp;
1605 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1606
1607 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1608 continue;
1609
1610 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1611 thread no longer exists. */
1612 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1613 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1614 continue;
1615
1616 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1617
1618 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1619 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1620 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1621 insert breakpoints. */
1622 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1623 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1624 continue;
1625
1626 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1627 &disabled_breaks,
1628 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1629 if (val)
1630 error = val;
1631 }
1632
1633 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1634 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1635 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1636 {
1637 int some_failed = 0;
1638 struct bp_location *loc;
1639
1640 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1641 continue;
1642
1643 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1644 continue;
1645
1646 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1647 continue;
1648
1649 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1650 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1651 {
1652 some_failed = 1;
1653 break;
1654 }
1655 if (some_failed)
1656 {
1657 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1658 if (loc->inserted)
1659 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1660
1661 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1664 bpt->number);
1665 error = -1;
1666 }
1667 }
1668
1669 if (error)
1670 {
1671 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1672 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1673 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1674 {
1675 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1676 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1677 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1678 }
1679 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1680 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1681 }
1682
1683 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1684 }
1685
1686 int
1687 remove_breakpoints (void)
1688 {
1689 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1690 int val = 0;
1691
1692 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1693 {
1694 if (b->inserted)
1695 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1696 }
1697 return val;
1698 }
1699
1700 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1701
1702 int
1703 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1704 {
1705 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1706 int val;
1707 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1708
1709 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1710 {
1711 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1712 continue;
1713
1714 if (b->inserted)
1715 {
1716 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1717 if (val != 0)
1718 return val;
1719 }
1720 }
1721 return 0;
1722 }
1723
1724 int
1725 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1726 {
1727 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1728 int val = 0;
1729
1730 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1731 {
1732 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1733 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1734 }
1735 return val;
1736 }
1737
1738 int
1739 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1740 {
1741 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1742 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1743 int val;
1744 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1745 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1746 struct inferior *inf;
1747 struct thread_info *tp;
1748
1749 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1750 if (tp == NULL)
1751 return 1;
1752
1753 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1754 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1755
1756 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1757
1758 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1759
1760 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1761 {
1762 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1763 continue;
1764
1765 if (b->inserted)
1766 {
1767 b->inserted = 0;
1768 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1769 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1770 if (val != 0)
1771 {
1772 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1773 return val;
1774 }
1775 }
1776 }
1777 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1778 return 0;
1779 }
1780
1781 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1782
1783 static struct breakpoint *
1784 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1785 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1786 {
1787 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1788 struct breakpoint *b;
1789
1790 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1791
1792 sal.pc = address;
1793 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1794 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1795
1796 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1797 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1798 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1799
1800 return b;
1801 }
1802
1803 static void
1804 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1805 {
1806 struct objfile *objfile;
1807
1808 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1809 {
1810 struct breakpoint *b;
1811 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1812
1813 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1814 if (m == NULL)
1815 continue;
1816
1817 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1818 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1819 bp_overlay_event);
1820 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1821
1822 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1823 {
1824 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1825 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1826 }
1827 else
1828 {
1829 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1830 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1831 }
1832 }
1833 update_global_location_list (1);
1834 }
1835
1836 static void
1837 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1838 {
1839 struct program_space *pspace;
1840 struct objfile *objfile;
1841 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1842
1843 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1844
1845 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1846 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1847 {
1848 struct breakpoint *b;
1849 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1850
1851 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1852 continue;
1853
1854 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1855
1856 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1857 if (m == NULL)
1858 continue;
1859
1860 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1861 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1862 bp_longjmp_master);
1863 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1864 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1865 }
1866 update_global_location_list (1);
1867
1868 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1869 }
1870
1871 void
1872 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1873 {
1874 struct breakpoint *b;
1875 struct breakpoint *temp;
1876 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1877
1878 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1879 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1880 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1881 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1882 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1883 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1884 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1885 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1886 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1887 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1888 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1889
1890 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1891 {
1892 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1893 continue;
1894
1895 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1896 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1897 {
1898 delete_breakpoint (b);
1899 continue;
1900 }
1901
1902 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1903 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1904 {
1905 delete_breakpoint (b);
1906 continue;
1907 }
1908
1909 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1910 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1911 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1912 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1913 {
1914 delete_breakpoint (b);
1915 continue;
1916 }
1917
1918 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1919 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1920 {
1921 delete_breakpoint (b);
1922 continue;
1923 }
1924
1925 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1926 after an exec. */
1927 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1928 {
1929 delete_breakpoint (b);
1930 continue;
1931 }
1932
1933 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1934 {
1935 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1936 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1937 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1938 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1939 continue;
1940 }
1941
1942 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1943 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1944 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1945 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1946 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1947 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1948
1949 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1950 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1951 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1952 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1953 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1954 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1955 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1956
1957 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1958 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1959 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1960 let finish_command delete it.
1961
1962 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1963 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1964 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1965 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1966 solib breakpoints.) */
1967
1968 if (b->type == bp_finish)
1969 {
1970 continue;
1971 }
1972
1973 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1974 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1975 a.out. */
1976 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1977 {
1978 delete_breakpoint (b);
1979 continue;
1980 }
1981 }
1982 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
1983 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1984 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1985 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1986 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1987 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1988 }
1989
1990 int
1991 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1992 {
1993 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1994 int val = 0;
1995 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1996 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1997
1998 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1999 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2000
2001 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2002 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2003 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2004 {
2005 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2006 continue;
2007
2008 if (b->inserted)
2009 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2010 }
2011 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2012 return val;
2013 }
2014
2015 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2016 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2017 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2018 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2019 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2020
2021 static int
2022 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2023 {
2024 int val;
2025 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2026
2027 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2028 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2029 return 0;
2030
2031 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2032 This should not ever happen. */
2033 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2034
2035 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2036 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037 {
2038 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2039 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2040 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2041
2042 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2043 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2044 || b->section == NULL
2045 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2046 {
2047 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2048
2049 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2050 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2051 else
2052 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2053 }
2054 else
2055 {
2056 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2057 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2058 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2059 {
2060 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2061 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2062 */
2063 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2064 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2065 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2066 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2067 &b->overlay_target_info);
2068 else
2069 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2070 &b->overlay_target_info);
2071 }
2072 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2073 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2074 if (b->inserted)
2075 {
2076 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2077 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2078 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2079 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2080 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2081 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2082 &b->target_info);
2083
2084 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2085 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2086 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2087 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2088 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2089 &b->target_info);
2090 else
2091 val = 0;
2092 }
2093 else
2094 {
2095 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2096 val = 0;
2097 }
2098 }
2099
2100 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2101 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2102 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2103 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2104 val = 0;
2105
2106 if (val)
2107 return val;
2108 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2109 }
2110 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2111 {
2112 struct value *v;
2113 struct value *n;
2114
2115 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2116 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2117 b->watchpoint_type);
2118
2119 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2120 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2121 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2122 b->owner->number);
2123 }
2124 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2125 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2126 && !b->duplicate)
2127 {
2128 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2129
2130 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2131 if (val)
2132 return val;
2133 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2134 }
2135
2136 return 0;
2137 }
2138
2139 static int
2140 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2141 {
2142 int ret;
2143 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2144
2145 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2146 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2147 return 0;
2148
2149 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2150 This should not ever happen. */
2151 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2152
2153 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2154
2155 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2156
2157 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2158
2159 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2160 return ret;
2161 }
2162
2163 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2164
2165 void
2166 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2167 {
2168 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2169
2170 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2171 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2172 bpt->inserted = 0;
2173 }
2174
2175 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2176 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2177
2178 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2179 between runs.
2180
2181 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2182 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2183 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2184
2185
2186
2187 void
2188 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2189 {
2190 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2191 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2192 int ix;
2193 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2194
2195 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2196 nothing to do. */
2197 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2198 return;
2199
2200 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2201 {
2202 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2203 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2204 bpt->inserted = 0;
2205 }
2206
2207 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2208 {
2209 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2210 continue;
2211
2212 switch (b->type)
2213 {
2214 case bp_call_dummy:
2215 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2216
2217 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2218 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2219 get rid of it.
2220
2221 Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2222 delete_breakpoint (b);
2223 break;
2224
2225 case bp_watchpoint:
2226 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2227 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2228 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2229
2230 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2231 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2232 delete_breakpoint (b);
2233 else if (context == inf_starting)
2234 {
2235 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2236 in insert_breakpoints. */
2237 if (b->val)
2238 value_free (b->val);
2239 b->val = NULL;
2240 b->val_valid = 0;
2241 }
2242 break;
2243 default:
2244 break;
2245 }
2246 }
2247
2248 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2249 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2250 free_bp_location (bpt);
2251 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2252 }
2253
2254 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2255 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2256 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2257 match, not program space. */
2258
2259 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2260 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2261 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2262 permanent breakpoint.
2263 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2264 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2265 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2266 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2267 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2268
2269 enum breakpoint_here
2270 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2271 {
2272 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2273 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2274
2275 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2276 {
2277 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2278 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2279 continue;
2280
2281 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2282 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2283 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2284 aspace, pc))
2285 {
2286 if (overlay_debugging
2287 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2288 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2289 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2290 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2291 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2292 else
2293 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2294 }
2295 }
2296
2297 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2298 }
2299
2300 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2301
2302 int
2303 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2304 {
2305 struct bp_location *loc;
2306 int ix;
2307
2308 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2309 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2310 aspace, pc))
2311 return 1;
2312
2313 return 0;
2314 }
2315
2316 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2317 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2318 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2319 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2320
2321 int
2322 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2323 {
2324 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2325
2326 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2327 {
2328 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2329 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2330 continue;
2331
2332 if (bpt->inserted
2333 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2334 aspace, pc))
2335 {
2336 if (overlay_debugging
2337 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2338 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2339 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2340 else
2341 return 1;
2342 }
2343 }
2344 return 0;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2348 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2349
2350 int
2351 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2352 {
2353 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2354 return 1;
2355
2356 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2357 return 1;
2358
2359 return 0;
2360 }
2361
2362 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2363 inserted at PC. */
2364
2365 int
2366 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2367 {
2368 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2369 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2370
2371 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2372 {
2373 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2374 continue;
2375
2376 if (bpt->inserted
2377 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2378 aspace, pc))
2379 {
2380 if (overlay_debugging
2381 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2382 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2383 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2384 else
2385 return 1;
2386 }
2387 }
2388
2389 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2390 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2391 return 1;
2392
2393 return 0;
2394 }
2395
2396 int
2397 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2398 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2399 {
2400 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2401
2402 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2403 {
2404 struct bp_location *loc;
2405
2406 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2407 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2408 continue;
2409
2410 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2411 continue;
2412
2413 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2414 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2415 {
2416 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2417
2418 /* Check for intersection. */
2419 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2420 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2421 if (l < h)
2422 return 1;
2423 }
2424 }
2425 return 0;
2426 }
2427
2428 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2429 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2430
2431 int
2432 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2433 ptid_t ptid)
2434 {
2435 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2436 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2437 int thread = -1;
2438 int task = 0;
2439
2440 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2441 {
2442 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2443 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2444 continue;
2445
2446 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2447 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2448 continue;
2449
2450 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2451 aspace, pc))
2452 continue;
2453
2454 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2455 {
2456 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2457 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2458 it is now time to do so. */
2459 if (thread == -1)
2460 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2461 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2462 continue;
2463 }
2464
2465 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2466 {
2467 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2468 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2469 it is now time to do so. */
2470 if (task == 0)
2471 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2472 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2473 continue;
2474 }
2475
2476 if (overlay_debugging
2477 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2478 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2479 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2480
2481 return 1;
2482 }
2483
2484 return 0;
2485 }
2486 \f
2487
2488 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2489 in breakpoint.h. */
2490
2491 int
2492 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2493 {
2494 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2495 }
2496
2497 void
2498 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2499 {
2500 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2501 value_free (bs->old_val);
2502 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2503 xfree (bs);
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2507 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2508
2509 void
2510 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2511 {
2512 bpstat p;
2513 bpstat q;
2514
2515 if (bsp == 0)
2516 return;
2517 p = *bsp;
2518 while (p != NULL)
2519 {
2520 q = p->next;
2521 bpstat_free (p);
2522 p = q;
2523 }
2524 *bsp = NULL;
2525 }
2526
2527 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2528 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2529
2530 bpstat
2531 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2532 {
2533 bpstat p = NULL;
2534 bpstat tmp;
2535 bpstat retval = NULL;
2536
2537 if (bs == NULL)
2538 return bs;
2539
2540 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2541 {
2542 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2543 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2544 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2545 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2546 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2547 {
2548 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2549 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2550 }
2551
2552 if (p == NULL)
2553 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2554 retval = tmp;
2555 else
2556 p->next = tmp;
2557 p = tmp;
2558 }
2559 p->next = NULL;
2560 return retval;
2561 }
2562
2563 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2564
2565 bpstat
2566 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2567 {
2568 if (bsp == NULL)
2569 return NULL;
2570
2571 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2572 {
2573 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2574 return bsp;
2575 }
2576 return NULL;
2577 }
2578
2579 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2580 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2581 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2582
2583 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2584 step_resume breakpoint.
2585
2586 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2587 struct breakpoint *
2588 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2589 {
2590 int current_thread;
2591
2592 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2593
2594 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2595
2596 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2597 {
2598 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2599 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2600 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2601 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2602 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2603 }
2604
2605 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2606 }
2607
2608
2609 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2610 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2611 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2612 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2613 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2614 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2615 we set it.
2616 Return 1 otherwise. */
2617
2618 int
2619 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2620 {
2621 struct breakpoint *b;
2622
2623 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2624 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2625
2626 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2627 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2628 this function might return the same number more
2629 than once and this will look ugly. */
2630 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2631 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2632 if (b == NULL)
2633 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2634
2635 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2636 return 1;
2637 }
2638
2639 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2640
2641 void
2642 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2643 {
2644 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2645 {
2646 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2647 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2648 {
2649 value_free (bs->old_val);
2650 bs->old_val = NULL;
2651 }
2652 }
2653 }
2654
2655 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2656
2657 static void
2658 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2659 {
2660 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2661 {
2662 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2663
2664 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2665 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2666 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2667 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2668 if (tp->in_infcall)
2669 return;
2670 }
2671
2672 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2673 }
2674
2675 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2676 static void
2677 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2678 {
2679 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2680 }
2681
2682 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2683 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2684 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2685 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2686
2687 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2688 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2689 bpstat of the current thread. */
2690
2691 static int
2692 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2693 {
2694 bpstat bs;
2695 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2696 int again = 0;
2697
2698 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2699 in bs->commands. */
2700 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2701 return 0;
2702
2703 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2704 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2705
2706 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2707 bs = *bsp;
2708
2709 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2710 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2711 {
2712 struct command_line *cmd;
2713 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2714
2715 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2716
2717 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2718 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2719 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2720 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2721 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2722 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2723 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2724 the tree when we're done. */
2725 cmd = bs->commands;
2726 bs->commands = 0;
2727 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2728
2729 while (cmd != NULL)
2730 {
2731 execute_control_command (cmd);
2732
2733 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2734 break;
2735 else
2736 cmd = cmd->next;
2737 }
2738
2739 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2740 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2741
2742 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2743 {
2744 if (target_can_async_p ())
2745 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2746 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2747 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2748 ;
2749 else
2750 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2751 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2752 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2753 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2754 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2755 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2756 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2757 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2758 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2759 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2760 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2761 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2762 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2763 again = 1;
2764 break;
2765 }
2766 }
2767 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2768 return again;
2769 }
2770
2771 void
2772 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2773 {
2774 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2775 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2776 && target_has_execution
2777 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2778 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2779 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2780 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2781 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2782 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2783 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2784 break;
2785 }
2786
2787 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2788
2789 static void
2790 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2791 {
2792 if (val == NULL)
2793 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2794 else
2795 {
2796 struct value_print_options opts;
2797 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2798 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2799 }
2800 }
2801
2802 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2803 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2804 by having it set different print_it values.
2805
2806 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2807 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2808 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2809 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2810 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2811
2812 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2813 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2814 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2815 don't print anything else.
2816 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2817 that something to be followed by a location.
2818 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2819 that something to be followed by a location.
2820 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2821 analysis. */
2822
2823 static enum print_stop_action
2824 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2825 {
2826 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2827 struct breakpoint *b;
2828 const struct bp_location *bl;
2829 struct ui_stream *stb;
2830 int bp_temp = 0;
2831 enum print_stop_action result;
2832
2833 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2834 which has since been deleted. */
2835 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2836 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2837 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2838 b = bl->owner;
2839
2840 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2841 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2842
2843 switch (b->type)
2844 {
2845 case bp_breakpoint:
2846 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2847 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2848 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2849 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2850 bl->address,
2851 b->number, 1);
2852 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2853 if (bp_temp)
2854 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2855 else
2856 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2857 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2858 {
2859 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2860 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2861 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2862 }
2863 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2864 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2865 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2866 break;
2867
2868 case bp_shlib_event:
2869 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2870 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2871 to shlib event" message.) */
2872 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2873 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874 break;
2875
2876 case bp_thread_event:
2877 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2878 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2879 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2880 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2881 break;
2882
2883 case bp_overlay_event:
2884 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2885 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2886 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2887 break;
2888
2889 case bp_longjmp_master:
2890 /* These should never be enabled. */
2891 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2892 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2893 break;
2894
2895 case bp_watchpoint:
2896 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2897 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2898 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2899 ui_out_field_string
2900 (uiout, "reason",
2901 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2902 mention (b);
2903 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2904 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2905 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2906 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2907 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2908 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2909 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2910 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2911 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2912 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2913 break;
2914
2915 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2916 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2917 ui_out_field_string
2918 (uiout, "reason",
2919 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2920 mention (b);
2921 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2922 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2923 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2924 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2925 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2926 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2927 break;
2928
2929 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2930 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2931 {
2932 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2933 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2934 ui_out_field_string
2935 (uiout, "reason",
2936 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2937 mention (b);
2938 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2940 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2941 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2942 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2943 }
2944 else
2945 {
2946 mention (b);
2947 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2948 ui_out_field_string
2949 (uiout, "reason",
2950 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2951 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2952 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2953 }
2954 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2955 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2956 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2957 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2958 break;
2959
2960 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2961 here. */
2962
2963 case bp_finish:
2964 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2965 ui_out_field_string
2966 (uiout, "reason",
2967 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2968 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2969 break;
2970
2971 case bp_until:
2972 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2973 ui_out_field_string
2974 (uiout, "reason",
2975 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2976 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2977 break;
2978
2979 case bp_none:
2980 case bp_longjmp:
2981 case bp_longjmp_resume:
2982 case bp_step_resume:
2983 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2984 case bp_call_dummy:
2985 case bp_tracepoint:
2986 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
2987 case bp_jit_event:
2988 default:
2989 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2990 break;
2991 }
2992
2993 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2994 return result;
2995 }
2996
2997 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2998 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2999 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3000 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3001 normal_stop(). */
3002
3003 static enum print_stop_action
3004 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3005 {
3006 switch (bs->print_it)
3007 {
3008 case print_it_noop:
3009 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3010 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3011 break;
3012
3013 case print_it_done:
3014 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3015 relevant messages. */
3016 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3017 break;
3018
3019 case print_it_normal:
3020 {
3021 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3022 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3023
3024 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3025 print_it_typical. */
3026 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3027 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3028 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3029 else
3030 return print_it_typical (bs);
3031 }
3032 break;
3033
3034 default:
3035 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3036 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3037 break;
3038 }
3039 }
3040
3041 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3042 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3043 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3044 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3045 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3046 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3047 routine is one of:
3048
3049 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3050 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3051 code to print the location. An example is
3052 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3053 the location.
3054 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3055 to also print the location part of the message.
3056 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3057 don't require a location appended to the end.
3058 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3059 further info to be printed.*/
3060
3061 enum print_stop_action
3062 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3063 {
3064 int val;
3065
3066 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3067 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3068 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3069 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3070 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3071 {
3072 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3073 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3074 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3075 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3076 return val;
3077 }
3078
3079 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3080 with and nothing was printed. */
3081 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3085 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3086 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3087 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3088
3089 static int
3090 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3091 {
3092 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3093 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3094 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3095 return i;
3096 }
3097
3098 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3099
3100 static bpstat
3101 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3102 {
3103 bpstat bs;
3104
3105 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3106 cbs->next = bs;
3107 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3108 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3109 bs->commands = NULL;
3110 bs->old_val = NULL;
3111 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3112 return bs;
3113 }
3114 \f
3115 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3116 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3117
3118 int
3119 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3120 {
3121 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3122 CORE_ADDR addr;
3123 struct breakpoint *b;
3124
3125 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3126 {
3127 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3128 as not triggered. */
3129 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3130 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3131 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3132 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3133 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3134
3135 return 0;
3136 }
3137
3138 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3139 {
3140 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3141 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3142 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3143 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3144 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3145 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3146 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3147
3148 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3149 }
3150
3151 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3152 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3153 triggered. */
3154
3155 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3156 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3157 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3158 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3159 {
3160 struct bp_location *loc;
3161 struct value *v;
3162
3163 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3164 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3165 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3166 sufficient. */
3167 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3168 addr, loc->address,
3169 loc->length))
3170 {
3171 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3172 break;
3173 }
3174 }
3175
3176 return 1;
3177 }
3178
3179 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3180 because of check_errors). */
3181 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3182 #define WP_DELETED 1
3183 /* The value has changed. */
3184 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3185 /* The value has not changed. */
3186 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3187
3188 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3189 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3190
3191 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3192
3193 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3194 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3195
3196 static int
3197 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3198 {
3199 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3200 struct breakpoint *b;
3201 struct frame_info *fr;
3202 int within_current_scope;
3203
3204 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3205
3206 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3207 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3208 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3209 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3210 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3211
3212 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3213 within_current_scope = 1;
3214 else
3215 {
3216 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3217 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3218 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3219
3220 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3221 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3222 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3223 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3224 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3225 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3226 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3227 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3228 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3229 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3230
3231 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3232 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3233
3234 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3235 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3236 if (within_current_scope)
3237 {
3238 struct symbol *function;
3239
3240 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3241 if (function == NULL
3242 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3243 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3244 within_current_scope = 0;
3245 }
3246
3247 if (within_current_scope)
3248 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3249 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3250 the user. */
3251 select_frame (fr);
3252 }
3253
3254 if (within_current_scope)
3255 {
3256 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3257 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3258 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3259 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3260
3261 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3262 struct value *new_val;
3263
3264 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3265
3266 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3267 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3268 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3269 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3270 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3271 {
3272 if (new_val != NULL)
3273 {
3274 release_value (new_val);
3275 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3276 }
3277 bs->old_val = b->val;
3278 b->val = new_val;
3279 b->val_valid = 1;
3280 /* We will stop here */
3281 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3282 }
3283 else
3284 {
3285 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3286 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3287 /* We won't stop here */
3288 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3289 }
3290 }
3291 else
3292 {
3293 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3294 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3295 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3296 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3297 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3298 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3299 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3300 the first value assigned). */
3301 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3302 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3303 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3304 information here. */
3305 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3306 ui_out_field_string
3307 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3308 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3309 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3310 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3311 which its expression is valid.\n");
3312
3313 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3314 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3315 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3316
3317 return WP_DELETED;
3318 }
3319 }
3320
3321 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3322 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3323 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3324 static int
3325 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3326 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3327 {
3328 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3329
3330 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3331 tracepoints. */
3332 if (tracepoint_type (b))
3333 return 0;
3334
3335 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3336 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3337 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3338 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3339 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3340 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3341 {
3342 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3343 aspace, bp_addr))
3344 return 0;
3345 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3346 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3347 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3348 return 0;
3349 }
3350
3351 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3352 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3353 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3354 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3355 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3356 (did not match the data address). */
3357
3358 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3359 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3360 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3361 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3362 return 0;
3363
3364 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3365 {
3366 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3367 return 0;
3368 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3369 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3370 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3371 return 0;
3372 }
3373
3374 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3375 {
3376 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3377 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3378 return 0;
3379 }
3380
3381 return 1;
3382 }
3383
3384 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3385 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3386 to 0. */
3387 static void
3388 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3389 {
3390 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3391 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3392
3393 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3394 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3395 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3396 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3397 {
3398 CORE_ADDR addr;
3399 struct value *v;
3400 int must_check_value = 0;
3401
3402 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3403 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3404 watched value. */
3405 must_check_value = 1;
3406 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3407 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3408 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3409 this watchpoint. */
3410 must_check_value = 1;
3411 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3412 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3413 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3414 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3415 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3416 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3417 must_check_value = 1;
3418
3419 if (must_check_value)
3420 {
3421 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3422 b->number);
3423 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3424 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3425 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3426 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3427 switch (e)
3428 {
3429 case WP_DELETED:
3430 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3431 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3432 /* Stop. */
3433 break;
3434 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3435 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3436 {
3437 /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3438 the value has changed. This is for targets
3439 which cannot set read-only watchpoints. */
3440 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3441 bs->stop = 0;
3442 }
3443 break;
3444 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3445 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3446 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3447 {
3448 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3449 the value hasn't changed. */
3450 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3451 bs->stop = 0;
3452 }
3453 /* Stop. */
3454 break;
3455 default:
3456 /* Can't happen. */
3457 case 0:
3458 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3459 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3460 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3461 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3462 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3463 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3464 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3465 break;
3466 }
3467 }
3468 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3469 {
3470 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3471 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3472 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3473 anything for this watchpoint. */
3474 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3475 bs->stop = 0;
3476 }
3477 }
3478 }
3479
3480
3481 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3482 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3483 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3484 static void
3485 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3486 {
3487 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3488 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3489 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3490
3491 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3492 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3493 bs->stop = 0;
3494 else if (bs->stop)
3495 {
3496 int value_is_zero = 0;
3497
3498 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3499 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3500 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3501 iteration. */
3502 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3503 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3504
3505 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3506 {
3507 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3508 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3509 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3510 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3511 function call. */
3512 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3513
3514 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3515 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3516 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3517 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3518 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3519 call site. */
3520 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3521 value_is_zero
3522 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3523 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3524 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3525 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3526 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3527 }
3528 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3529 {
3530 bs->stop = 0;
3531 }
3532 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3533 {
3534 bs->stop = 0;
3535 }
3536 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3537 {
3538 b->ignore_count--;
3539 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3540 bs->stop = 0;
3541 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3542 stop. */
3543 ++(b->hit_count);
3544 }
3545 }
3546 }
3547
3548
3549 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3550 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3551
3552 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3553 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3554
3555 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3556
3557 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3558
3559 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3560 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3561 several reasons concurrently.)
3562
3563 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3564 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3565
3566 bpstat
3567 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3568 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3569 {
3570 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3571 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3572 struct bp_location *loc;
3573 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3574 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3575 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3576 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3577 int ix;
3578 int need_remove_insert;
3579
3580 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3581 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3582 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3583
3584 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3585 {
3586 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3587 continue;
3588
3589 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3590 {
3591 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3592 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3593 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3594 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3595 already. */
3596 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3597 break;
3598
3599 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3600 continue;
3601
3602 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3603 continue;
3604
3605 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3606
3607 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3608
3609 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3610 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3611 'stop' to 0. */
3612 bs->stop = 1;
3613 bs->print = 1;
3614
3615 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3616 if (!bs->stop)
3617 continue;
3618
3619 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3620 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3621 /* We do not stop for these. */
3622 bs->stop = 0;
3623 else
3624 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3625
3626 if (bs->stop)
3627 {
3628 ++(b->hit_count);
3629
3630 /* We will stop here */
3631 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3632 {
3633 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3634 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3635 update_global_location_list (0);
3636 }
3637 if (b->silent)
3638 bs->print = 0;
3639 bs->commands = b->commands;
3640 if (bs->commands
3641 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3642 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3643 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3644 {
3645 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3646 bs->print = 0;
3647 }
3648 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3649 }
3650
3651 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3652 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3653 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3654 }
3655 }
3656
3657 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3658 {
3659 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3660 aspace, bp_addr))
3661 {
3662 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3663 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3664 bs->stop = 0;
3665 bs->print = 0;
3666 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3667 }
3668 }
3669
3670 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3671
3672 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3673 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3674 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3675 done later. */
3676 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3677 if (bs->stop)
3678 break;
3679
3680 need_remove_insert = 0;
3681 if (bs == NULL)
3682 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3683 if (!bs->stop
3684 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3685 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3686 {
3687 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3688 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3689 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3690 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3691 need_remove_insert = 1;
3692 }
3693
3694 if (need_remove_insert)
3695 update_global_location_list (1);
3696
3697 return root_bs->next;
3698 }
3699 \f
3700 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3701 struct bpstat_what
3702 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3703 {
3704 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3705 enum class
3706 {
3707 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3708 no_effect = 0,
3709
3710 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3711 wp_silent,
3712
3713 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3714 wp_noisy,
3715
3716 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3717 bp_nostop,
3718
3719 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3720 bp_silent,
3721
3722 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3723 bp_noisy,
3724
3725 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3726 long_jump,
3727
3728 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3729 long_resume,
3730
3731 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3732 step_resume,
3733
3734 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3735 shlib_event,
3736
3737 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3738 jit_event,
3739
3740 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3741 class_last
3742 };
3743
3744 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3745 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3746 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3747 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3748 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3749 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3750 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3751 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3752 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3753 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3754 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3755 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3756
3757 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3758 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3759 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3760 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3761
3762 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3763 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3764 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3765 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3766 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3767 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3768 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3769
3770 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3771 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3772 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3773 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3774 ordering is:
3775
3776 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3777 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3778 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3779 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3780 ss < jit shl sn sr
3781 sn < jit shl sr
3782 jit < shl sr
3783 shl < sr
3784 sr <
3785
3786 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3787 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3788 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3789 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3790 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3791
3792 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3793 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3794 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3795
3796 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3797 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3798 {
3799 /* old action */
3800 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3801 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3802 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3803 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3804 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3805 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3806 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3807 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3808 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3809 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3810 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3811 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3812 };
3813
3814 #undef kc
3815 #undef ss
3816 #undef sn
3817 #undef sgl
3818 #undef slr
3819 #undef clr
3820 #undef err
3821 #undef sr
3822 #undef ts
3823 #undef shl
3824 #undef jit
3825 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3826 struct bpstat_what retval;
3827
3828 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3829 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3830 {
3831 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3832 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3833 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3834 which has since been deleted. */
3835 continue;
3836 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3837 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3838 else
3839 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3840 {
3841 case bp_none:
3842 continue;
3843
3844 case bp_breakpoint:
3845 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3846 case bp_until:
3847 case bp_finish:
3848 if (bs->stop)
3849 {
3850 if (bs->print)
3851 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3852 else
3853 bs_class = bp_silent;
3854 }
3855 else
3856 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3857 break;
3858 case bp_watchpoint:
3859 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3860 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3861 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3862 if (bs->stop)
3863 {
3864 if (bs->print)
3865 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3866 else
3867 bs_class = wp_silent;
3868 }
3869 else
3870 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3871 This requires no further action. */
3872 bs_class = no_effect;
3873 break;
3874 case bp_longjmp:
3875 bs_class = long_jump;
3876 break;
3877 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3878 bs_class = long_resume;
3879 break;
3880 case bp_step_resume:
3881 if (bs->stop)
3882 {
3883 bs_class = step_resume;
3884 }
3885 else
3886 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3887 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3888 break;
3889 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3890 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3891 break;
3892 case bp_shlib_event:
3893 bs_class = shlib_event;
3894 break;
3895 case bp_jit_event:
3896 bs_class = jit_event;
3897 break;
3898 case bp_thread_event:
3899 case bp_overlay_event:
3900 case bp_longjmp_master:
3901 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3902 break;
3903 case bp_catchpoint:
3904 if (bs->stop)
3905 {
3906 if (bs->print)
3907 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3908 else
3909 bs_class = bp_silent;
3910 }
3911 else
3912 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3913 This requires no further action. */
3914 bs_class = no_effect;
3915 break;
3916 case bp_call_dummy:
3917 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3918 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
3919 bs_class = bp_silent;
3920 retval.call_dummy = 1;
3921 break;
3922 case bp_tracepoint:
3923 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3924 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3925 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3926 out already. */
3927 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3928 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
3929 break;
3930 }
3931 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3932 }
3933 retval.main_action = current_action;
3934 return retval;
3935 }
3936
3937 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3938 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3939 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
3940
3941 int
3942 bpstat_should_step (void)
3943 {
3944 struct breakpoint *b;
3945 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3946 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3947 return 1;
3948 return 0;
3949 }
3950
3951 int
3952 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3953 {
3954 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3955 if (bs->stop)
3956 return 1;
3957
3958 return 0;
3959 }
3960
3961 \f
3962
3963 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
3964
3965 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3966 struct bp_location *loc,
3967 char *wrap_indent,
3968 struct ui_stream *stb)
3969 {
3970 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3971
3972 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
3973 loc = NULL;
3974
3975 if (loc != NULL)
3976 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3977
3978 if (b->source_file && loc)
3979 {
3980 struct symbol *sym
3981 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3982 if (sym)
3983 {
3984 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3985 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3986 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3987 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3988 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3989 }
3990 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3991 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3992
3993 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3994 {
3995 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3996 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3997
3998 if (fullname)
3999 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4000 }
4001
4002 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4003 }
4004 else if (loc)
4005 {
4006 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4007 demangle, "");
4008 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4009 }
4010 else
4011 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4012
4013 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4014 }
4015
4016 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4017 static void
4018 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4019 struct bp_location *loc,
4020 int loc_number,
4021 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4022 int print_address_bits,
4023 int allflag)
4024 {
4025 struct command_line *l;
4026 struct symbol *sym;
4027 struct ep_type_description
4028 {
4029 enum bptype type;
4030 char *description;
4031 };
4032 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4033 {
4034 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4035 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4036 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4037 {bp_until, "until"},
4038 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4039 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4040 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4041 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4042 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4043 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4044 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4045 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4046 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4047 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4048 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4049 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4050 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4051 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4052 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4053 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4054 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4055 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4056 };
4057
4058 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4059 char wrap_indent[80];
4060 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4061 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4062 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4063
4064 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4065 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4066 struct value_print_options opts;
4067
4068 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4069
4070 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4071 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4072 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4073 location. */
4074 if (loc == NULL
4075 && (b->loc != NULL
4076 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4077 header_of_multiple = 1;
4078 if (loc == NULL)
4079 loc = b->loc;
4080
4081 annotate_record ();
4082 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4083
4084 /* 1 */
4085 annotate_field (0);
4086 if (part_of_multiple)
4087 {
4088 char *formatted;
4089 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4090 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4091 xfree (formatted);
4092 }
4093 else
4094 {
4095 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4096 }
4097
4098 /* 2 */
4099 annotate_field (1);
4100 if (part_of_multiple)
4101 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4102 else
4103 {
4104 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4105 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4106 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4107 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4108 (int) b->type);
4109 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4110 }
4111
4112 /* 3 */
4113 annotate_field (2);
4114 if (part_of_multiple)
4115 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4116 else
4117 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4118
4119
4120 /* 4 */
4121 annotate_field (3);
4122 if (part_of_multiple)
4123 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4124 else
4125 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4126 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4127 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4128
4129
4130 /* 5 and 6 */
4131 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4132 if (opts.addressprint)
4133 {
4134 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4135 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4136 else
4137 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4138 }
4139
4140 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4141 {
4142 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4143 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4144 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4145 just one location. */
4146 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4147 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4148 }
4149 else
4150 switch (b->type)
4151 {
4152 case bp_none:
4153 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4154 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4155 break;
4156
4157 case bp_watchpoint:
4158 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4159 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4160 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4161 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4162 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4163 is relatively readable). */
4164 if (opts.addressprint)
4165 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4166 annotate_field (5);
4167 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4168 break;
4169
4170 case bp_breakpoint:
4171 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4172 case bp_until:
4173 case bp_finish:
4174 case bp_longjmp:
4175 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4176 case bp_step_resume:
4177 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4178 case bp_call_dummy:
4179 case bp_shlib_event:
4180 case bp_thread_event:
4181 case bp_overlay_event:
4182 case bp_longjmp_master:
4183 case bp_tracepoint:
4184 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4185 case bp_jit_event:
4186 if (opts.addressprint)
4187 {
4188 annotate_field (4);
4189 if (header_of_multiple)
4190 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4191 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4192 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4193 else
4194 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4195 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4196 }
4197 annotate_field (5);
4198 if (!header_of_multiple)
4199 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4200 if (b->loc)
4201 *last_loc = b->loc;
4202 break;
4203 }
4204
4205
4206 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4207 are several. */
4208 if (loc != NULL
4209 && !header_of_multiple
4210 && (allflag
4211 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4212 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4213 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4214 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4215 {
4216 struct inferior *inf;
4217 int first = 1;
4218
4219 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4220 {
4221 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4222 {
4223 if (first)
4224 {
4225 first = 0;
4226 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4227 }
4228 else
4229 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4230 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4231 }
4232 }
4233 }
4234
4235 if (!part_of_multiple)
4236 {
4237 if (b->thread != -1)
4238 {
4239 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4240 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4241 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4242 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4243 }
4244 else if (b->task != 0)
4245 {
4246 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4247 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4248 }
4249 }
4250
4251 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4252
4253 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4254 {
4255 annotate_field (6);
4256 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4257 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4258 the frame ID. */
4259 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4260 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4261 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4262 }
4263
4264 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4265 {
4266 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4267 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4268 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4269 annotate_field (7);
4270 if (tracepoint_type (b))
4271 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4272 else
4273 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4274 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4275 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4276 }
4277
4278 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4279 {
4280 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4281 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4282 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4283 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4284 }
4285
4286 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4287 {
4288 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4289 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4290 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4291 else
4292 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4293 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4294 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4295 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4296 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4297 else
4298 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4299 }
4300
4301 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4302 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4303 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4304 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4305 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4306
4307 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4308 {
4309 annotate_field (8);
4310 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4311 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4312 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4313 }
4314
4315 l = b->commands;
4316 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4317 {
4318 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4319
4320 annotate_field (9);
4321 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4322 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4323 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4324 }
4325
4326 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4327 {
4328 annotate_field (10);
4329 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4330 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4331 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4332 }
4333
4334 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4335 {
4336 annotate_field (11);
4337 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4338 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4339 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4340 }
4341
4342 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4343 {
4344 struct action_line *action;
4345 annotate_field (12);
4346 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4347 {
4348 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4349 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4350 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4351 }
4352 }
4353
4354 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4355 {
4356 if (b->addr_string)
4357 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4358 else if (b->exp_string)
4359 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4360 }
4361
4362 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4363 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4364 }
4365
4366 static void
4367 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4368 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4369 int allflag)
4370 {
4371 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4372 print_address_bits, allflag);
4373
4374 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4375 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4376 locations, if any. */
4377 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4378 {
4379 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4380 disabled, we print it as if it had
4381 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4382 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4383 situation.
4384 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4385 several locations internally, that's no a property
4386 exposed to user. */
4387 if (b->loc
4388 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4389 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4390 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4391 {
4392 struct bp_location *loc;
4393 int n = 1;
4394 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4395 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4396 print_address_bits, allflag);
4397 }
4398 }
4399 }
4400
4401 static int
4402 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4403 {
4404 int print_address_bits = 0;
4405 struct bp_location *loc;
4406
4407 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4408 {
4409 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4410 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4411 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4412 }
4413
4414 return print_address_bits;
4415 }
4416
4417 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4418 {
4419 int bnum;
4420 };
4421
4422 static int
4423 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4424 {
4425 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4426 struct breakpoint *b;
4427 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4428 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4429 {
4430 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4431 {
4432 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4433 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4434 return GDB_RC_OK;
4435 }
4436 }
4437 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4438 }
4439
4440 enum gdb_rc
4441 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4442 {
4443 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4444 args.bnum = bnum;
4445 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4446 an error. */
4447 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4448 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4449 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4450 else
4451 return GDB_RC_OK;
4452 }
4453
4454 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4455 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4456
4457 static int
4458 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4459 {
4460 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4461 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4462 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4463 || tracepoint_type (b)
4464 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4465 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4466 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4467 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4468 }
4469
4470 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4471 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4472 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4473
4474 static void
4475 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4476 {
4477 struct breakpoint *b;
4478 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4479 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4480 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4481 struct value_print_options opts;
4482 int print_address_bits = 0;
4483
4484 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4485
4486 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4487 size required for address fields. */
4488 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4489 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4490 if (bnum == -1
4491 || bnum == b->number)
4492 {
4493 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4494 {
4495 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4496 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4497 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4498
4499 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4500 }
4501 }
4502
4503 if (opts.addressprint)
4504 bkpttbl_chain
4505 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4506 "BreakpointTable");
4507 else
4508 bkpttbl_chain
4509 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4510 "BreakpointTable");
4511
4512 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4513 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4514 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4515 annotate_field (0);
4516 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4517 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4518 annotate_field (1);
4519 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4520 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4521 annotate_field (2);
4522 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4524 annotate_field (3);
4525 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4526 if (opts.addressprint)
4527 {
4528 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4529 annotate_field (4);
4530 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4531 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4532 else
4533 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4534 }
4535 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4536 annotate_field (5);
4537 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4538 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4539 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4540 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4541
4542 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4543 if (bnum == -1
4544 || bnum == b->number)
4545 {
4546 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4547 allflag is set. */
4548 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4549 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4550 }
4551
4552 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4553
4554 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4555 {
4556 if (bnum == -1)
4557 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4558 else
4559 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4560 bnum);
4561 }
4562 else
4563 {
4564 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4565 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4566 }
4567
4568 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4569 there have been breakpoints? */
4570 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4571 }
4572
4573 static void
4574 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4575 {
4576 int bnum = -1;
4577
4578 if (bnum_exp)
4579 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4580
4581 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4582 }
4583
4584 static void
4585 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4586 {
4587 int bnum = -1;
4588
4589 if (bnum_exp)
4590 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4591
4592 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4593 }
4594
4595 static int
4596 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4597 struct program_space *pspace,
4598 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4599 {
4600 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4601 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4602 {
4603 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4604 && bl->address == pc
4605 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4606 return 1;
4607 }
4608 return 0;
4609 }
4610
4611 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4612 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4613 address spaces. */
4614
4615 static void
4616 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4617 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4618 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4619 {
4620 int others = 0;
4621 struct breakpoint *b;
4622
4623 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4624 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4625 if (others > 0)
4626 {
4627 if (others == 1)
4628 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4629 else /* if (others == ???) */
4630 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4631 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4632 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4633 {
4634 others--;
4635 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4636 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4637 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4638 else if (b->thread != -1)
4639 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4640 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4641 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4642 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4643 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4644 ? " (disabled)"
4645 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4646 ? " (permanent)"
4647 : ""),
4648 (others > 1) ? ","
4649 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4650 }
4651 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4652 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4653 printf_filtered (".\n");
4654 }
4655 }
4656 \f
4657 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4658 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4659
4660 void
4661 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4662 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4663 int line)
4664 {
4665 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4666 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4667 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4668 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4669 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4670 }
4671
4672 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4673 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4674 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4675 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4676
4677 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4678 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4679 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4680
4681 bp_watchpoint
4682 bp_catchpoint
4683
4684 */
4685
4686 static int
4687 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4688 {
4689 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4690
4691 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4692 }
4693
4694 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4695 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4696
4697 static int
4698 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4699 {
4700 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4701 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4702 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4703 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4704 }
4705
4706 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4707 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4708 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4709 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4710
4711 static int
4712 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4713 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4714 {
4715 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4716 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4717 && addr1 == addr2);
4718 }
4719
4720 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4721 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4722 represent the same location. */
4723
4724 static int
4725 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4726 {
4727 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4728 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4729
4730 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4731 return 0;
4732 else if (hw_point1)
4733 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4734 else
4735 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4736 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4737 }
4738
4739 static void
4740 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4741 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4742 {
4743 char astr1[40];
4744 char astr2[40];
4745
4746 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4747 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4748 if (have_bnum)
4749 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4750 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4751 else
4752 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4753 }
4754
4755 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4756 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4757 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4758 this function is simply the identity function. */
4759
4760 static CORE_ADDR
4761 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4762 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4763 {
4764 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4765 {
4766 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4767 return bpaddr;
4768 }
4769 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4770 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4771 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4772 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4773 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4774 {
4775 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4776 have their addresses modified. */
4777 return bpaddr;
4778 }
4779 else
4780 {
4781 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4782
4783 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4784 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4785 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4786
4787 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4788 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4789 is required. */
4790 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4791 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4792
4793 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4794 }
4795 }
4796
4797 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4798
4799 static struct bp_location *
4800 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4801 {
4802 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4803
4804 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4805 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4806
4807 loc->owner = bpt;
4808 loc->cond = NULL;
4809 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4810 loc->enabled = 1;
4811
4812 switch (bpt->type)
4813 {
4814 case bp_breakpoint:
4815 case bp_until:
4816 case bp_finish:
4817 case bp_longjmp:
4818 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4819 case bp_step_resume:
4820 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4821 case bp_call_dummy:
4822 case bp_shlib_event:
4823 case bp_thread_event:
4824 case bp_overlay_event:
4825 case bp_jit_event:
4826 case bp_longjmp_master:
4827 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4828 break;
4829 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4830 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4831 break;
4832 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4833 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4834 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4835 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4836 break;
4837 case bp_watchpoint:
4838 case bp_catchpoint:
4839 case bp_tracepoint:
4840 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4841 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4842 break;
4843 default:
4844 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4845 }
4846
4847 return loc;
4848 }
4849
4850 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4851 {
4852 if (loc->cond)
4853 xfree (loc->cond);
4854
4855 if (loc->function_name)
4856 xfree (loc->function_name);
4857
4858 xfree (loc);
4859 }
4860
4861 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4862 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4863 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4864
4865 static struct breakpoint *
4866 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4867 enum bptype bptype)
4868 {
4869 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4870
4871 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4872 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4873
4874 b->type = bptype;
4875 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4876 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4877 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4878 b->thread = -1;
4879 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4880 b->next = 0;
4881 b->silent = 0;
4882 b->ignore_count = 0;
4883 b->commands = NULL;
4884 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4885 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4886 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4887 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4888 b->ops = NULL;
4889 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4890
4891 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4892 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4893 of increasing numbers. */
4894
4895 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4896 if (b1 == 0)
4897 breakpoint_chain = b;
4898 else
4899 {
4900 while (b1->next)
4901 b1 = b1->next;
4902 b1->next = b;
4903 }
4904 return b;
4905 }
4906
4907 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
4908 static void
4909 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4910 {
4911 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4912 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4913 || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
4914 {
4915 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4916 NULL, NULL);
4917 if (loc->function_name)
4918 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4919 }
4920 }
4921
4922 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
4923 static struct gdbarch *
4924 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4925 {
4926 if (sal.section)
4927 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4928 if (sal.symtab)
4929 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4930
4931 return NULL;
4932 }
4933
4934 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4935 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
4936 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4937 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
4938 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4939 is also returned as the value of this function.
4940
4941 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4942 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4943 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
4944 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4945 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4946 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
4947 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
4948
4949 struct breakpoint *
4950 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4951 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4952 {
4953 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4954 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4955 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4956
4957 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4958 if (!loc_gdbarch)
4959 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4960
4961 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4962 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4963
4964 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4965 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4966 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
4967 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4968 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4969 location that's only been partially initialized. */
4970 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4971
4972 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4973 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4974 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4975 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4976 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4977
4978 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4979 breakpoint resetting. */
4980 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4981
4982 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4983 b->source_file = NULL;
4984 else
4985 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4986 b->loc->section = sal.section;
4987 b->line_number = sal.line;
4988
4989 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4990
4991 breakpoints_changed ();
4992
4993 return b;
4994 }
4995
4996
4997 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4998 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
4999 void
5000 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5001 {
5002 struct bp_location *bl;
5003 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5004
5005 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5006 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5007 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5008 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5009 but it's easy to implmement. */
5010 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5011 bl->inserted = 1;
5012 }
5013
5014 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5015 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5016 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5017
5018 void
5019 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5020 {
5021 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5022
5023 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5024 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5025 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5026 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5027 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5028 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5029 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5030 {
5031 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5032 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5033 clone->thread = thread;
5034 }
5035 }
5036
5037 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5038 void
5039 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5040 {
5041 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5042
5043 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5044 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5045 {
5046 if (b->thread == thread)
5047 delete_breakpoint (b);
5048 }
5049 }
5050
5051 void
5052 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5053 {
5054 struct breakpoint *b;
5055
5056 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5057 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5058 {
5059 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5060 update_global_location_list (1);
5061 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5062 }
5063 }
5064
5065 void
5066 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5067 {
5068 struct breakpoint *b;
5069
5070 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5071 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5072 {
5073 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5074 update_global_location_list (0);
5075 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5076 }
5077 }
5078
5079 struct breakpoint *
5080 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5081 {
5082 struct breakpoint *b;
5083
5084 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5085
5086 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5087 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5088 b->addr_string
5089 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5090
5091 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5092
5093 return b;
5094 }
5095
5096 void
5097 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5098 {
5099 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5100
5101 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5102 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5103 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5104 delete_breakpoint (b);
5105 }
5106
5107 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5108 {
5109 char **arg_p;
5110 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5111 char ***addr_string_p;
5112 int *not_found_ptr;
5113 };
5114
5115 struct lang_and_radix
5116 {
5117 enum language lang;
5118 int radix;
5119 };
5120
5121 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5122
5123 struct breakpoint *
5124 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5125 {
5126 struct breakpoint *b;
5127
5128 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5129 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5130 return b;
5131 }
5132
5133 void
5134 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5135 {
5136 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5137
5138 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5139 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5140 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5141 delete_breakpoint (b);
5142 }
5143
5144 struct breakpoint *
5145 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5146 {
5147 struct breakpoint *b;
5148
5149 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5150 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5151 return b;
5152 }
5153
5154 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5155 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5156
5157 void
5158 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5159 {
5160 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5161
5162 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5163 {
5164 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5165 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5166 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5167 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5168 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5169 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5170 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5171 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5172 || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5173 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5174 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5175 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5176 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5177 #else
5178 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5179 #endif
5180 )
5181 {
5182 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5183 }
5184 }
5185 }
5186
5187 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5188 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5189
5190 static void
5191 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5192 {
5193 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5194 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5195
5196 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5197 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5198 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5199 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5200 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5201 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5202 return;
5203
5204 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5205 {
5206 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5207 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5208 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5209 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5210 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5211 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5212 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5213 {
5214 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5215 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5216 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5217 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5218 loc->inserted = 0;
5219 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5220 {
5221 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5222 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5223 solib->so_name);
5224 }
5225 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5226 }
5227 }
5228 }
5229
5230 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5231
5232 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5233
5234 static void
5235 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5236 {
5237 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5238 }
5239
5240 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5241
5242 static int
5243 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5244 {
5245 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5246 }
5247
5248 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5249 catchpoints. */
5250
5251 static int
5252 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5253 {
5254 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5255 }
5256
5257 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5258
5259 static enum print_stop_action
5260 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5261 {
5262 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5263 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5264 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5265 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5266 }
5267
5268 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5269
5270 static void
5271 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5272 {
5273 struct value_print_options opts;
5274
5275 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5276
5277 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5278 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5279 is relatively readable). */
5280 if (opts.addressprint)
5281 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5282 annotate_field (5);
5283 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5284 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5285 {
5286 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5287 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5288 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5289 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5290 }
5291 }
5292
5293 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5294 catchpoints. */
5295
5296 static void
5297 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5298 {
5299 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5300 }
5301
5302 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5303
5304 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5305 {
5306 insert_catch_fork,
5307 remove_catch_fork,
5308 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5309 print_it_catch_fork,
5310 print_one_catch_fork,
5311 print_mention_catch_fork
5312 };
5313
5314 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5315
5316 static void
5317 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5318 {
5319 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5323
5324 static int
5325 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5326 {
5327 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5328 }
5329
5330 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5331 catchpoints. */
5332
5333 static int
5334 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5335 {
5336 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5337 }
5338
5339 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5340
5341 static enum print_stop_action
5342 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5343 {
5344 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5345 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5346 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5347 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5348 }
5349
5350 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5351
5352 static void
5353 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5354 {
5355 struct value_print_options opts;
5356
5357 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5358 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5359 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5360 is relatively readable). */
5361 if (opts.addressprint)
5362 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5363 annotate_field (5);
5364 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5365 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5366 {
5367 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5368 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5369 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5370 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5371 }
5372 }
5373
5374 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5375 catchpoints. */
5376
5377 static void
5378 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5379 {
5380 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5381 }
5382
5383 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5384
5385 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5386 {
5387 insert_catch_vfork,
5388 remove_catch_vfork,
5389 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5390 print_it_catch_vfork,
5391 print_one_catch_vfork,
5392 print_mention_catch_vfork
5393 };
5394
5395 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5396 catchpoints. */
5397
5398 static void
5399 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5400 {
5401 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5402
5403 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5404 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5405 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5406 else
5407 {
5408 int i, iter;
5409 for (i = 0;
5410 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5411 i++)
5412 {
5413 int elem;
5414 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5415 {
5416 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5417 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5418 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5419 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5420 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5421 vec_addr_offset;
5422 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5423 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5424 }
5425 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5426 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5427 }
5428 }
5429
5430 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5431 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5432 inf->any_syscall_count,
5433 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5434 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5435 }
5436
5437 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5438 catchpoints. */
5439
5440 static int
5441 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5442 {
5443 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5444
5445 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5446 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5447 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5448 else
5449 {
5450 int i, iter;
5451 for (i = 0;
5452 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5453 i++)
5454 {
5455 int elem;
5456 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5457 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5458 continue;
5459 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5460 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5461 }
5462 }
5463
5464 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5465 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5466 inf->any_syscall_count,
5467 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5468 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5469 }
5470
5471 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5472 catchpoints. */
5473
5474 static int
5475 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5476 {
5477 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5478 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5479 syscall we are catching. */
5480 int syscall_number = 0;
5481
5482 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5483 return 0;
5484
5485 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5486 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5487 {
5488 int i, iter;
5489 for (i = 0;
5490 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5491 i++)
5492 if (syscall_number == iter)
5493 break;
5494 /* Not the same. */
5495 if (!iter)
5496 return 0;
5497 }
5498
5499 return 1;
5500 }
5501
5502 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5503 catchpoints. */
5504
5505 static enum print_stop_action
5506 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5507 {
5508 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5509 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5510 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5511 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5512 ptid_t ptid;
5513 struct target_waitstatus last;
5514 struct syscall s;
5515 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5516 char *syscall_id;
5517
5518 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5519
5520 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5521
5522 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5523
5524 if (s.name == NULL)
5525 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5526 else
5527 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5528
5529 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5530
5531 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5532 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5533 b->number, syscall_id);
5534 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5535 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5536 b->number, syscall_id);
5537
5538 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5539
5540 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5541 }
5542
5543 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5544 catchpoints. */
5545
5546 static void
5547 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5548 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5549 {
5550 struct value_print_options opts;
5551
5552 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5553 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5554 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5555 is relatively readable). */
5556 if (opts.addressprint)
5557 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5558 annotate_field (5);
5559
5560 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5561 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5562 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5563 else
5564 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5565
5566 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5567 {
5568 int i, iter;
5569 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5570 for (i = 0;
5571 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5572 i++)
5573 {
5574 char *x = text;
5575 struct syscall s;
5576 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5577
5578 if (s.name != NULL)
5579 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5580 else
5581 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5582
5583 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5584 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5585 on every call. */
5586 xfree (x);
5587 }
5588 /* Remove the last comma. */
5589 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5590 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5591 }
5592 else
5593 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5594 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5595 }
5596
5597 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5598 catchpoints. */
5599
5600 static void
5601 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5602 {
5603 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5604 {
5605 int i, iter;
5606
5607 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5608 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5609 else
5610 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5611
5612 for (i = 0;
5613 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5614 i++)
5615 {
5616 struct syscall s;
5617 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5618
5619 if (s.name)
5620 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5621 else
5622 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5623 }
5624 printf_filtered (")");
5625 }
5626 else
5627 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5628 b->number);
5629 }
5630
5631 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5632
5633 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5634 {
5635 insert_catch_syscall,
5636 remove_catch_syscall,
5637 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5638 print_it_catch_syscall,
5639 print_one_catch_syscall,
5640 print_mention_catch_syscall
5641 };
5642
5643 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5644
5645 static int
5646 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5647 {
5648 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5649 }
5650
5651 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5652 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5653 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5654 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5655
5656 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5657 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5658 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5659 to the catchpoint. */
5660
5661 static struct breakpoint *
5662 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5663 char *cond_string,
5664 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5665 {
5666 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5667 struct breakpoint *b;
5668
5669 init_sal (&sal);
5670 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5671
5672 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5673 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5674 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5675
5676 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5677 b->thread = -1;
5678 b->addr_string = NULL;
5679 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5680 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5681 b->ops = ops;
5682
5683 return b;
5684 }
5685
5686 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5687
5688 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5689 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5690 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5691 to the catchpoint. */
5692
5693 static struct breakpoint *
5694 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5695 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5696 {
5697 struct breakpoint *b =
5698 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5699
5700 mention (b);
5701 update_global_location_list (1);
5702
5703 return b;
5704 }
5705
5706 static void
5707 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5708 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5709 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5710 {
5711 struct breakpoint *b
5712 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5713
5714 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5715 area. */
5716 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5717 }
5718
5719 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5720
5721 static void
5722 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5723 {
5724 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5725 }
5726
5727 static int
5728 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5729 {
5730 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5731 }
5732
5733 static int
5734 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5735 {
5736 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5737 }
5738
5739 static enum print_stop_action
5740 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5741 {
5742 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5743 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5744 b->exec_pathname);
5745 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5746 }
5747
5748 static void
5749 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5750 {
5751 struct value_print_options opts;
5752
5753 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5754
5755 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5756 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5757 is relatively readable). */
5758 if (opts.addressprint)
5759 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5760 annotate_field (5);
5761 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5762 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5763 {
5764 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5765 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5766 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5767 }
5768 }
5769
5770 static void
5771 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5772 {
5773 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5774 }
5775
5776 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5777 {
5778 insert_catch_exec,
5779 remove_catch_exec,
5780 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5781 print_it_catch_exec,
5782 print_one_catch_exec,
5783 print_mention_catch_exec
5784 };
5785
5786 static void
5787 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5788 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5789 {
5790 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5791 struct breakpoint *b =
5792 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5793
5794 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5795
5796 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5797 location list. */
5798 mention (b);
5799 update_global_location_list (1);
5800 }
5801
5802 static int
5803 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5804 {
5805 struct breakpoint *b;
5806 int i = 0;
5807
5808 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5809 {
5810 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5811 i++;
5812 }
5813
5814 return i;
5815 }
5816
5817 static int
5818 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5819 {
5820 struct breakpoint *b;
5821 int i = 0;
5822
5823 *other_type_used = 0;
5824 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5825 {
5826 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5827 {
5828 if (b->type == type)
5829 i++;
5830 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5831 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5832 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5833 *other_type_used = 1;
5834 }
5835 }
5836 return i;
5837 }
5838
5839 void
5840 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5841 {
5842 struct breakpoint *b;
5843
5844 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5845 {
5846 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5847 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5848 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5849 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5850 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5851 {
5852 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5853 update_global_location_list (0);
5854 }
5855 }
5856 }
5857
5858 void
5859 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5860 {
5861 struct breakpoint *b;
5862
5863 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5864 {
5865 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5866 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5867 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5868 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5869 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5870 {
5871 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5872 update_global_location_list (1);
5873 }
5874 }
5875 }
5876
5877 void
5878 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5879 {
5880 struct breakpoint *b;
5881 int found = 0;
5882
5883 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5884 {
5885 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5886 continue;
5887
5888 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5889 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5890 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5891 {
5892 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5893 found = 1;
5894 }
5895 }
5896
5897 if (found)
5898 update_global_location_list (0);
5899
5900 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5901 }
5902
5903 void
5904 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5905 {
5906 struct breakpoint *b;
5907 int found = 0;
5908
5909 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5910
5911 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5912 {
5913 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5914 continue;
5915
5916 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5917 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5918 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5919 {
5920 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5921 found = 1;
5922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 if (found)
5926 breakpoint_re_set ();
5927 }
5928
5929
5930 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5931 at address specified by SAL.
5932 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
5933
5934 struct breakpoint *
5935 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5936 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5937 {
5938 struct breakpoint *b;
5939
5940 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5941 one. */
5942 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5943
5944 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5945 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5946 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5947 b->frame_id = frame_id;
5948
5949 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5950 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5951 single thread of control. */
5952 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5953 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5954
5955 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5956
5957 return b;
5958 }
5959
5960 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
5961 ORIG is NULL. */
5962
5963 struct breakpoint *
5964 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5965 {
5966 struct breakpoint *copy;
5967
5968 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
5969 if (orig == NULL)
5970 return NULL;
5971
5972 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5973 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5974 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5975
5976 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5977 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5978 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5979 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5980 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5981
5982 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5983 copy->source_file = NULL;
5984 else
5985 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5986
5987 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5988 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5989 copy->thread = orig->thread;
5990 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5991
5992 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5993 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5994 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5995
5996 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5997 return copy;
5998 }
5999
6000 struct breakpoint *
6001 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6002 enum bptype type)
6003 {
6004 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6005
6006 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6007 sal.pc = pc;
6008 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6009 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6010
6011 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6012 }
6013 \f
6014
6015 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6016
6017 static void
6018 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6019 {
6020 int say_where = 0;
6021 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6022 struct value_print_options opts;
6023
6024 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6025
6026 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6027 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6028 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6029 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6030 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6031
6032 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6033 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6034 else
6035 switch (b->type)
6036 {
6037 case bp_none:
6038 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6039 break;
6040 case bp_watchpoint:
6041 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6042 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6043 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6044 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6045 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6046 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6047 break;
6048 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6049 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6050 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6051 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6052 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6053 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6054 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6055 break;
6056 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6057 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6058 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6059 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6060 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6061 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6062 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6063 break;
6064 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6065 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6066 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6067 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6068 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6069 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6070 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6071 break;
6072 case bp_breakpoint:
6073 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6074 {
6075 say_where = 0;
6076 break;
6077 }
6078 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6079 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6080 else
6081 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6082 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6083 say_where = 1;
6084 break;
6085 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6086 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6087 {
6088 say_where = 0;
6089 break;
6090 }
6091 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6092 say_where = 1;
6093 break;
6094 case bp_tracepoint:
6095 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6096 {
6097 say_where = 0;
6098 break;
6099 }
6100 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6101 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6102 say_where = 1;
6103 break;
6104 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6105 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6106 {
6107 say_where = 0;
6108 break;
6109 }
6110 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6111 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6112 say_where = 1;
6113 break;
6114
6115 case bp_until:
6116 case bp_finish:
6117 case bp_longjmp:
6118 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6119 case bp_step_resume:
6120 case bp_call_dummy:
6121 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6122 case bp_shlib_event:
6123 case bp_thread_event:
6124 case bp_overlay_event:
6125 case bp_jit_event:
6126 case bp_longjmp_master:
6127 break;
6128 }
6129
6130 if (say_where)
6131 {
6132 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6133 single string. */
6134 if (b->loc == NULL)
6135 {
6136 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6137 }
6138 else
6139 {
6140 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6141 {
6142 printf_filtered (" at ");
6143 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6144 gdb_stdout);
6145 }
6146 if (b->source_file)
6147 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6148 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6149
6150 if (b->loc->next)
6151 {
6152 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6153 int n = 0;
6154 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6155 ++n;
6156 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6157 }
6158
6159 }
6160 }
6161 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6162 return;
6163 printf_filtered ("\n");
6164 }
6165 \f
6166
6167 static struct bp_location *
6168 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6169 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6170 {
6171 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6172
6173 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6174 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6175 ;
6176 *tmp = loc;
6177 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6178 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6179 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6180 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6181 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6182 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6183 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6184 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6185 loc->section = sal->section;
6186
6187 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6188 return loc;
6189 }
6190 \f
6191
6192 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6193 return 0 otherwise. */
6194
6195 static int
6196 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6197 {
6198 int len;
6199 CORE_ADDR addr;
6200 const gdb_byte *brk;
6201 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6202 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6203 int retval = 0;
6204
6205 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6206
6207 addr = loc->address;
6208 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6209
6210 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6211 if (brk == NULL)
6212 return 0;
6213
6214 target_mem = alloca (len);
6215
6216 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6217 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6218 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6219 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6220
6221 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6222 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6223
6224 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6225 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6226 retval = 1;
6227
6228 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6229
6230 return retval;
6231 }
6232
6233
6234
6235 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6236 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6237 as condition expression. */
6238
6239 static void
6240 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6241 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6242 char *cond_string,
6243 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6244 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6245 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6246 {
6247 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6248 int i;
6249
6250 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6251 {
6252 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6253 int target_resources_ok =
6254 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6255 i + 1, 0);
6256 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6257 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6258 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6259 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6260 }
6261
6262 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6263
6264 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6265 {
6266 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6267 struct bp_location *loc;
6268
6269 if (from_tty)
6270 {
6271 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6272 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6273 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6274
6275 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6276 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6277 }
6278
6279 if (i == 0)
6280 {
6281 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6282 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6283 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6284 b->thread = thread;
6285 b->task = task;
6286
6287 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6288 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6289 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6290 b->disposition = disposition;
6291
6292 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6293
6294 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6295 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6296 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6297 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6298
6299 loc = b->loc;
6300 }
6301 else
6302 {
6303 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6304 }
6305
6306 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6307 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6308
6309 if (b->cond_string)
6310 {
6311 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6312 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6313 if (*arg)
6314 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6315 }
6316 }
6317
6318 if (addr_string)
6319 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6320 else
6321 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6322 me. */
6323 b->addr_string
6324 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6325
6326 b->ops = ops;
6327 mention (b);
6328 }
6329
6330 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6331 elements to fill the void space. */
6332 static void
6333 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6334 {
6335 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6336 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6337
6338 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6339 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6340
6341 --(sal->nelts);
6342 }
6343
6344 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6345 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6346 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6347 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6348 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6349 single expanded sal, return the original.
6350
6351 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6352 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6353 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6354 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6355 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6356
6357 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6358 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6359 {
6360 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6361 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6362 char *original_function = NULL;
6363 int found;
6364 int i;
6365 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6366
6367 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6368 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6369 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6370 {
6371 expanded.nelts = 1;
6372 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6373 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6374 return expanded;
6375 }
6376
6377 sal.pc = 0;
6378
6379 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6380
6381 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6382
6383 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6384
6385 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6386 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6387
6388 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6389 {
6390 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6391 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6392 xfree (expanded.sals);
6393 expanded.nelts = 1;
6394 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6395 sal.pc = original_pc;
6396 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6397 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6398 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6399 return expanded;
6400 }
6401
6402 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6403 {
6404 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6405 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6406 {
6407 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6408 char *this_function;
6409
6410 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6411 read memory. */
6412 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6413
6414 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6415 &func_addr, &func_end))
6416 {
6417 if (this_function
6418 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6419 {
6420 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6421 --i;
6422 }
6423 else if (func_addr == pc)
6424 {
6425 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6426 skip prologue. */
6427 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6428 if (sym)
6429 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6430 else
6431 {
6432 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6433 we should really always find the section here. */
6434 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6435 if (section)
6436 {
6437 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6438 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6439 expanded.sals[i].pc
6440 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6441 }
6442 }
6443 }
6444 }
6445 }
6446 }
6447 else
6448 {
6449 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6450 {
6451 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6452 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6453 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6454 }
6455 }
6456
6457 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6458
6459 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6460 {
6461 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6462 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6463 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6464 xfree (expanded.sals);
6465 expanded.nelts = 1;
6466 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6467 sal.pc = original_pc;
6468 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6469 return expanded;
6470 }
6471
6472 if (original_pc)
6473 {
6474 found = 0;
6475 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6476 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6477 {
6478 found = 1;
6479 break;
6480 }
6481 gdb_assert (found);
6482 }
6483
6484 return expanded;
6485 }
6486
6487 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6488 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6489 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6490 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6491 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6492 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6493 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6494 we take just a single condition string.
6495
6496 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6497 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6498 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6499 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6500 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6501
6502 static void
6503 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6504 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6505 char *cond_string,
6506 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6507 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6508 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6509 int enabled)
6510 {
6511 int i;
6512 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6513 {
6514 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6515 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6516
6517 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6518 cond_string, type, disposition,
6519 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6520 }
6521 }
6522
6523 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6524 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6525 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6526 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6527
6528 static void
6529 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6530 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6531 char ***addr_string,
6532 int *not_found_ptr)
6533 {
6534 char *addr_start = *address;
6535 *addr_string = NULL;
6536 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6537 breakpoint. */
6538 if ((*address) == NULL
6539 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6540 {
6541 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6542 {
6543 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6544 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6545 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6546 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6547 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6548 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6549 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6550 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6551 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6552
6553 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6554 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6555 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6556 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6557 */
6558 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6559
6560 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6561 sals->nelts = 1;
6562 }
6563 else
6564 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6565 }
6566 else
6567 {
6568 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6569 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6570 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6571 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6572 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6573 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6574
6575 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6576
6577 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6578 && (!cursal.symtab
6579 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6580 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6581 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6582 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6583 not_found_ptr);
6584 else
6585 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6586 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6587 }
6588 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6589 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6590 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6591 if (addr_start != (*address))
6592 {
6593 int i;
6594 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6595 {
6596 /* Add the string if not present. */
6597 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6598 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6599 }
6600 }
6601 }
6602
6603
6604 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6605 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6606
6607 static void
6608 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6609 char *address)
6610 {
6611 int i;
6612 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6613 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6614 }
6615
6616 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
6617 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6618 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6619 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6620 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6621 it, etc. */
6622
6623 static void
6624 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6625 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6626 {
6627 int i, rslt;
6628 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6629 char *msg;
6630 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6631
6632 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6633 {
6634 sal = &sals->sals[i];
6635
6636 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6637 NULL, &msg);
6638 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6639
6640 if (!rslt)
6641 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6642 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6643
6644 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6645 }
6646 }
6647
6648 static void
6649 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6650 {
6651 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6652
6653 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6654 args->not_found_ptr);
6655 }
6656
6657 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6658 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6659 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6660 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6661 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6662 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6663 static void
6664 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6665 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6666 {
6667 *cond_string = NULL;
6668 *thread = -1;
6669 while (tok && *tok)
6670 {
6671 char *end_tok;
6672 int toklen;
6673 char *cond_start = NULL;
6674 char *cond_end = NULL;
6675 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6676 tok++;
6677
6678 end_tok = tok;
6679
6680 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6681 end_tok++;
6682
6683 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6684
6685 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6686 {
6687 struct expression *expr;
6688
6689 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6690 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6691 xfree (expr);
6692 cond_end = tok;
6693 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6694 cond_end - cond_start);
6695 }
6696 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6697 {
6698 char *tmptok;
6699
6700 tok = end_tok + 1;
6701 tmptok = tok;
6702 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6703 if (tok == tmptok)
6704 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6705 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6706 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6707 }
6708 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6709 {
6710 char *tmptok;
6711
6712 tok = end_tok + 1;
6713 tmptok = tok;
6714 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6715 if (tok == tmptok)
6716 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6717 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6718 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6719 }
6720 else
6721 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6722 }
6723 }
6724
6725 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
6726 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
6727 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
6728 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6729 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
6730 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
6731 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
6732 was created; false otherwise. */
6733
6734 static int
6735 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6736 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6737 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6738 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6739 int ignore_count,
6740 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6741 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6742 int from_tty,
6743 int enabled)
6744 {
6745 struct gdb_exception e;
6746 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6747 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6748 char *copy_arg;
6749 char *err_msg;
6750 char *addr_start = arg;
6751 char **addr_string;
6752 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6753 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6754 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6755 int i;
6756 int pending = 0;
6757 int not_found = 0;
6758 enum bptype type_wanted;
6759 int task = 0;
6760
6761 sals.sals = NULL;
6762 sals.nelts = 0;
6763 addr_string = NULL;
6764
6765 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6766 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6767 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6768 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6769
6770 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6771 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6772
6773 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6774 switch (e.reason)
6775 {
6776 case RETURN_QUIT:
6777 throw_exception (e);
6778 case RETURN_ERROR:
6779 switch (e.error)
6780 {
6781 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6782
6783 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6784 error. */
6785
6786 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6787 throw_exception (e);
6788
6789 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6790
6791 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6792 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6793 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6794 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6795 return 0;
6796
6797 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6798 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6799 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6800 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6801 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6802 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6803 sals.nelts = 1;
6804 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6805 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6806 pending = 1;
6807 break;
6808 default:
6809 throw_exception (e);
6810 }
6811 default:
6812 if (!sals.nelts)
6813 return 0;
6814 }
6815
6816 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6817 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6818
6819 if (!pending)
6820 {
6821 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6822 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6823
6824 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6825 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6826 }
6827
6828 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6829 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6830 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6831 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6832 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6833
6834 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6835 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6836 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6837 {
6838 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6839 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6840 }
6841
6842 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6843 are ok for the target. */
6844 if (!pending)
6845 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6846
6847 type_wanted = (traceflag
6848 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
6849 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6850
6851 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
6852 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
6853 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
6854
6855 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6856 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6857 breakpoint. */
6858 if (!pending)
6859 {
6860 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6861 {
6862 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6863 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6864 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6865 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6866 cond_string = NULL;
6867 thread = -1;
6868 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6869 &thread, &task);
6870 if (cond_string)
6871 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6872 }
6873 else
6874 {
6875 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6876 if (cond_string)
6877 {
6878 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6879 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6880 }
6881 }
6882 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6883 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6884 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6885 }
6886 else
6887 {
6888 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6889 struct breakpoint *b;
6890
6891 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6892
6893 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6894 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6895 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6896 b->thread = -1;
6897 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6898 b->cond_string = NULL;
6899 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6900 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6901 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6902 b->ops = ops;
6903 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6904 b->pspace = current_program_space;
6905
6906 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6907 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6908 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6909 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6910
6911 mention (b);
6912 }
6913
6914 if (sals.nelts > 1)
6915 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6916 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6917 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6918 breakpoint. */
6919 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6920 /* But cleanup everything else. */
6921 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6922
6923 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
6924 update_global_location_list (1);
6925
6926 return 1;
6927 }
6928
6929 /* Set a breakpoint.
6930 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6931 condition, and thread.
6932 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6933 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6934 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
6935
6936 static void
6937 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6938 {
6939 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6940 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6941
6942 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6943 arg,
6944 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6945 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6946 0 /* Ignore count */,
6947 pending_break_support,
6948 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6949 from_tty,
6950 1 /* enabled */);
6951 }
6952
6953
6954 void
6955 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6956 char *address, char *condition,
6957 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6958 int thread, int ignore_count,
6959 int pending, int enabled)
6960 {
6961 break_command_really (gdbarch,
6962 address, condition, thread,
6963 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
6964 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6965 ignore_count,
6966 pending
6967 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6968 NULL, 0, enabled);
6969 }
6970
6971 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6972 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6973 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6974 not modified.
6975
6976 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
6977
6978 static void
6979 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6980 {
6981 struct symbol *sym;
6982 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6983 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6984
6985 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6986
6987 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6988 if (sym != NULL)
6989 {
6990 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6991 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6992 {
6993 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6994 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6995 *sal = start_sal;
6996 }
6997 }
6998
6999 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7000 }
7001
7002 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7003
7004 void
7005 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7006 {
7007 CORE_ADDR pc;
7008
7009 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7010 {
7011 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7012 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7013 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7014 sal->pc = pc;
7015
7016 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7017 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7018 if (sal->explicit_line)
7019 {
7020 /* Preserve the original line number. */
7021 int saved_line = sal->line;
7022 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7023 sal->line = saved_line;
7024 }
7025 }
7026
7027 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7028 {
7029 struct blockvector *bv;
7030 struct block *b;
7031 struct symbol *sym;
7032
7033 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7034 if (bv != NULL)
7035 {
7036 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7037 if (sym != NULL)
7038 {
7039 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7040 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7041 }
7042 else
7043 {
7044 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7045 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7046 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7047 source). */
7048
7049 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7050 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7051
7052 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7053
7054 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7055 if (msym)
7056 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7057
7058 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7059 }
7060 }
7061 }
7062 }
7063
7064 void
7065 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7066 {
7067 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7068 }
7069
7070 void
7071 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7072 {
7073 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7074 }
7075
7076 static void
7077 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7078 {
7079 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7080 }
7081
7082 static void
7083 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7084 {
7085 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7086 }
7087
7088 static void
7089 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7090 {
7091 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7092 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7093 stop at <line>\n"));
7094 }
7095
7096 static void
7097 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7098 {
7099 int badInput = 0;
7100
7101 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7102 badInput = 1;
7103 else if (*arg != '*')
7104 {
7105 char *argptr = arg;
7106 int hasColon = 0;
7107
7108 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7109 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7110 function/method name */
7111 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7112 {
7113 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7114 argptr++;
7115 }
7116
7117 if (hasColon)
7118 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7119 else
7120 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7121 }
7122
7123 if (badInput)
7124 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7125 else
7126 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7127 }
7128
7129 static void
7130 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7131 {
7132 int badInput = 0;
7133
7134 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7135 badInput = 1;
7136 else
7137 {
7138 char *argptr = arg;
7139 int hasColon = 0;
7140
7141 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7142 it is probably a line number. */
7143 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7144 {
7145 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7146 argptr++;
7147 }
7148
7149 if (hasColon)
7150 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7151 else
7152 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7153 }
7154
7155 if (badInput)
7156 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7157 else
7158 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7159 }
7160
7161 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7162 hw_read: watch read,
7163 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7164 static void
7165 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7166 {
7167 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7168 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7169 struct expression *exp;
7170 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7171 struct value *val, *mark;
7172 struct frame_info *frame;
7173 char *exp_start = NULL;
7174 char *exp_end = NULL;
7175 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7176 int toklen;
7177 char *cond_start = NULL;
7178 char *cond_end = NULL;
7179 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7180 enum bptype bp_type;
7181 int mem_cnt = 0;
7182 int thread = -1;
7183
7184 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7185 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7186 {
7187 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7188
7189 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7190 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7191
7192 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7193 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7194 be the thread identifier. */
7195 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7196 tok--;
7197 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7198 tok--;
7199
7200 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7201 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7202
7203 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7204 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7205 reach a "thread" token. */
7206 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7207 tok--;
7208
7209 end_tok = tok;
7210
7211 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7212 tok--;
7213
7214 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7215 calculate the length of the token. */
7216 tok++;
7217 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7218
7219 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7220 {
7221 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7222 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7223 only in a specific thread. */
7224 char *endp;
7225
7226 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7227 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7228
7229 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7230 thread ID. */
7231 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7232 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7233
7234 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7235 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7236 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7237
7238 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7239 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7240 evaluate_expression() function. */
7241 *tok = '\0';
7242 }
7243 }
7244
7245 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7246 innermost_block = NULL;
7247 exp_start = arg;
7248 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7249 exp_end = arg;
7250 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7251 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7252 prettier. */
7253 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7254 --exp_end;
7255
7256 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7257 mark = value_mark ();
7258 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7259 if (val != NULL)
7260 release_value (val);
7261
7262 tok = arg;
7263 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7264 tok++;
7265 end_tok = tok;
7266
7267 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7268 end_tok++;
7269
7270 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7271 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7272 {
7273 struct expression *cond;
7274
7275 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7276 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7277 xfree (cond);
7278 cond_end = tok;
7279 }
7280 if (*tok)
7281 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7282
7283 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7284 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7285 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7286 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7287 else
7288 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7289
7290 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7291 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7292 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7293 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7294 {
7295 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7296 target_resources_ok =
7297 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7298 other_type_used);
7299 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7300 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7301
7302 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7303 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7304 }
7305
7306 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7307 watchpoint could not be set. */
7308 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7309 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7310
7311 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7312
7313 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7314 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7315 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7316 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7317 if (innermost_block && frame)
7318 {
7319 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7320 {
7321 scope_breakpoint
7322 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7323 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7324 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7325
7326 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7327
7328 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7329 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7330
7331 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7332 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7333
7334 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7335 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7336 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7337 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7338 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7339 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7340 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7341 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7342 scope_breakpoint->type);
7343 }
7344 }
7345
7346 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7347 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7348 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7349 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7350 b->thread = thread;
7351 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7352 b->exp = exp;
7353 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7354 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7355 b->val = val;
7356 b->val_valid = 1;
7357 if (cond_start)
7358 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7359 else
7360 b->cond_string = 0;
7361
7362 if (frame)
7363 {
7364 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7365 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7366 }
7367 else
7368 {
7369 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7370 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7371 }
7372
7373 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7374 {
7375 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7376 need to act on them together. */
7377 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7378 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7379 }
7380
7381 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7382
7383 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7384 that should be inserted. */
7385 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7386
7387 mention (b);
7388 update_global_location_list (1);
7389 }
7390
7391 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7392 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7393 in hardware return zero. */
7394
7395 static int
7396 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7397 {
7398 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7399 struct value *head = v;
7400
7401 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7402 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7403 return 0;
7404
7405 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7406 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7407 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7408 hardware watchpoint.
7409
7410 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7411 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7412 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7413 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7414 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7415 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7416 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7417 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7418 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7419
7420 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7421 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7422 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7423 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7424 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7425 {
7426 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7427 {
7428 if (value_lazy (v))
7429 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7430 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7431 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7432 ;
7433 else
7434 {
7435 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7436 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7437 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7438
7439 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7440 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7441 middle of some value chain. */
7442 if (v == head
7443 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7444 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7445 {
7446 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7447 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7448
7449 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7450 return 0;
7451 else
7452 found_memory_cnt++;
7453 }
7454 }
7455 }
7456 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7457 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7458 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7459 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7460 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7461 }
7462
7463 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7464 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7465 return found_memory_cnt;
7466 }
7467
7468 void
7469 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7470 {
7471 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7472 }
7473
7474 static void
7475 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7476 {
7477 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7478 }
7479
7480 void
7481 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7482 {
7483 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7484 }
7485
7486 static void
7487 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7488 {
7489 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7490 }
7491
7492 void
7493 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7494 {
7495 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7496 }
7497
7498 static void
7499 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7500 {
7501 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7502 }
7503 \f
7504
7505 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7506 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7507
7508 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7509 {
7510 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7511 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7512 };
7513
7514 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7515 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7516 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7517 command. */
7518 static void
7519 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7520 {
7521 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7522
7523 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7524 if (a->breakpoint2)
7525 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7526 }
7527
7528 void
7529 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7530 {
7531 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7532 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7533 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7534 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7535 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7536 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7537
7538 clear_proceed_status ();
7539
7540 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7541 this function */
7542
7543 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7544 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7545 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7546 else
7547 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7548 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7549
7550 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7551 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7552
7553 sal = sals.sals[0];
7554 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7555
7556 if (*arg)
7557 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7558
7559 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7560
7561 if (anywhere)
7562 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7563 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7564 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7565 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7566 else
7567 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7568 at the very same frame. */
7569 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7570 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7571 bp_until);
7572
7573 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7574
7575 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7576 one. */
7577
7578 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7579 {
7580 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7581 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7582 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7583 sal,
7584 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7585 bp_until);
7586 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7587 }
7588
7589 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7590
7591 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7592 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7593 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7594 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7595
7596 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7597 {
7598 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7599 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7600
7601 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7602 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7603
7604 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7605 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7606 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7607 xfree);
7608 }
7609 else
7610 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7611 }
7612
7613 static void
7614 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7615 {
7616 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7617 return;
7618 while (isspace (**s))
7619 *s += 1;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7623 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7624
7625 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7626 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7627 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7628 if clause in the arg string. */
7629
7630 static char *
7631 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7632 {
7633 char *cond_string;
7634
7635 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7636 return NULL;
7637
7638 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7639 (*arg) += 2;
7640
7641 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7642 condition string. */
7643 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7644 cond_string = *arg;
7645
7646 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7647 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7648
7649 return cond_string;
7650 }
7651
7652 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7653 process start/exit, etc. */
7654
7655 typedef enum
7656 {
7657 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7658 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7659 }
7660 catch_fork_kind;
7661
7662 static void
7663 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7664 {
7665 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7666 char *cond_string = NULL;
7667 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7668 int tempflag;
7669
7670 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7671 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7672 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7673
7674 if (!arg)
7675 arg = "";
7676 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7677
7678 /* The allowed syntax is:
7679 catch [v]fork
7680 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7681
7682 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7683 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7684
7685 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7686 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7687
7688 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7689 and enable reporting of such events. */
7690 switch (fork_kind)
7691 {
7692 case catch_fork_temporary:
7693 case catch_fork_permanent:
7694 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7695 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7696 break;
7697 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7698 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7699 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7700 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7701 break;
7702 default:
7703 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7704 break;
7705 }
7706 }
7707
7708 static void
7709 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7710 {
7711 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7712 int tempflag;
7713 char *cond_string = NULL;
7714
7715 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7716
7717 if (!arg)
7718 arg = "";
7719 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7720
7721 /* The allowed syntax is:
7722 catch exec
7723 catch exec if <cond>
7724
7725 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7726 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7727
7728 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7729 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7730
7731 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7732 and enable reporting of such events. */
7733 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7734 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7735 }
7736
7737 static enum print_stop_action
7738 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7739 {
7740 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7741
7742 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7743
7744 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7745 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7746 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7747 b->loc->address,
7748 b->number, 1);
7749 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7750 ui_out_text (uiout,
7751 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7752 : "Catchpoint ");
7753 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7754 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7755 ui_out_text (uiout,
7756 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7757 : " (exception caught), ");
7758 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7759 {
7760 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7761 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7762 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7763 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7764 }
7765 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7766 }
7767
7768 static void
7769 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7770 {
7771 struct value_print_options opts;
7772 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7773 if (opts.addressprint)
7774 {
7775 annotate_field (4);
7776 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7777 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7778 else
7779 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7780 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7781 }
7782 annotate_field (5);
7783 if (b->loc)
7784 *last_loc = b->loc;
7785 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7786 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7787 else
7788 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7789 }
7790
7791 static void
7792 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7793 {
7794 int bp_temp;
7795 int bp_throw;
7796
7797 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7798 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7799 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7800 : _("Catchpoint "));
7801 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7802 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7803 : _(" (catch)"));
7804 }
7805
7806 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7807 NULL, /* insert */
7808 NULL, /* remove */
7809 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7810 print_exception_catchpoint,
7811 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7812 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7813 };
7814
7815 static int
7816 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7817 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7818 {
7819 char *trigger_func_name;
7820
7821 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7822 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7823 else
7824 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7825
7826 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7827 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7828 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7829 tempflag, 0, 0,
7830 0,
7831 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7832 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7833 1 /* enabled */);
7834
7835 return 1;
7836 }
7837
7838 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7839
7840 static void
7841 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7842 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7843 {
7844 char *cond_string = NULL;
7845 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7846
7847 if (!arg)
7848 arg = "";
7849 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7850
7851 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7852
7853 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7854 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7855
7856 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7857 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7858 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7859
7860 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7861 return;
7862
7863 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7864 }
7865
7866 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7867
7868 static void
7869 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7870 {
7871 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7872 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7873 }
7874
7875 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7876
7877 static void
7878 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7879 {
7880 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7881 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7882 }
7883
7884 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
7885
7886 static void
7887 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7888 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7889 char *addr_string,
7890 char *exp_string,
7891 char *cond_string,
7892 struct expression *cond,
7893 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7894 int tempflag,
7895 int from_tty)
7896 {
7897 struct breakpoint *b;
7898
7899 if (from_tty)
7900 {
7901 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7902 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7903 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7904
7905 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7906 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7907 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7908 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7909 used for different exception names will use the same address.
7910 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7911 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7912 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7913 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
7914 enough for now, though. */
7915 }
7916
7917 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7918 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7919
7920 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7921 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7922 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7923 b->ignore_count = 0;
7924 b->loc->cond = cond;
7925 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7926 b->language = language_ada;
7927 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7928 b->exp_string = exp_string;
7929 b->thread = -1;
7930 b->ops = ops;
7931
7932 mention (b);
7933 update_global_location_list (1);
7934 }
7935
7936 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
7937
7938 static void
7939 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7940 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7941 {
7942 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7943 int tempflag;
7944 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7945 enum bptype type;
7946 char *addr_string = NULL;
7947 char *exp_string = NULL;
7948 char *cond_string = NULL;
7949 struct expression *cond = NULL;
7950 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7951
7952 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7953
7954 if (!arg)
7955 arg = "";
7956 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7957 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7958 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7959 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7960 from_tty);
7961 }
7962
7963 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
7964 static void
7965 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7966 {
7967 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7968 VEC_free (int, iter);
7969 }
7970
7971 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
7972 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
7973 static VEC(int) *
7974 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7975 {
7976 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7977 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7978
7979 while (*arg != '\0')
7980 {
7981 int i, syscall_number;
7982 char *endptr;
7983 char cur_name[128];
7984 struct syscall s;
7985
7986 /* Skip whitespace. */
7987 while (isspace (*arg))
7988 arg++;
7989
7990 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7991 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7992 cur_name[i] = '\0';
7993 arg += i;
7994
7995 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
7996 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7997 if (*endptr == '\0')
7998 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7999 else
8000 {
8001 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8002 to a number. */
8003 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8004
8005 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8006 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8007 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8008 be caught. */
8009 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8010 }
8011
8012 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8013 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8014 }
8015
8016 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8017 return result;
8018 }
8019
8020 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8021
8022 static void
8023 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8024 {
8025 int tempflag;
8026 VEC(int) *filter;
8027 struct syscall s;
8028 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8029
8030 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8031 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8032 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8033 this architeture yet."));
8034
8035 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8036
8037 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8038
8039 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8040 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8041 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8042 for his/her architecture. */
8043 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8044
8045 /* The allowed syntax is:
8046 catch syscall
8047 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8048
8049 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8050
8051 if (arg != NULL)
8052 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8053 else
8054 filter = NULL;
8055
8056 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8057 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8058 }
8059
8060 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8061
8062 static void
8063 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8064 {
8065 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8066 int tempflag;
8067 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8068 char *addr_string = NULL;
8069 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8070
8071 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8072
8073 if (!arg)
8074 arg = "";
8075 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8076 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8077 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8078 }
8079
8080 static void
8081 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8082 {
8083 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8084 }
8085 \f
8086
8087 static void
8088 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8089 {
8090 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8091 }
8092
8093 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8094
8095 static void
8096 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8097 {
8098 struct breakpoint *b;
8099 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8100 int ix;
8101 int default_match;
8102 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8103 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8104 int i;
8105
8106 if (arg)
8107 {
8108 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8109 default_match = 0;
8110 }
8111 else
8112 {
8113 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8114 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8115 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8116 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8117 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8118 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8119 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8120 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8121 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8122 error (_("No source file specified."));
8123
8124 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8125 sals.nelts = 1;
8126
8127 default_match = 1;
8128 }
8129
8130 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8131 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8132 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8133 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8134 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8135
8136 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8137 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8138 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8139 due to optimization, all in one block.
8140 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8141 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8142 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8143 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8144 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8145 to support that. */
8146
8147 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8148 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8149 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8150 one breakpoint. */
8151
8152 found = NULL;
8153 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8154 {
8155 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8156 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8157 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8158 or at default pc.
8159
8160 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8161
8162 0 1 pc
8163 1 1 pc _and_ line
8164 0 0 line
8165 1 0 <can't happen> */
8166
8167 sal = sals.sals[i];
8168
8169 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8170 'found'. */
8171 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8172 {
8173 int match = 0;
8174 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8175 if (b->type != bp_none
8176 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8177 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8178 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8179 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8180 {
8181 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8182 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8183 {
8184 int pc_match = sal.pc
8185 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8186 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8187 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8188 || loc->section == sal.section);
8189 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8190 && b->source_file != NULL
8191 && sal.symtab != NULL
8192 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8193 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8194 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8195 if (pc_match || line_match)
8196 {
8197 match = 1;
8198 break;
8199 }
8200 }
8201 }
8202
8203 if (match)
8204 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8205 }
8206 }
8207 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8208 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8209 {
8210 if (arg)
8211 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8212 else
8213 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8214 }
8215
8216 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8217 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8218 if (from_tty)
8219 {
8220 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8221 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8222 else
8223 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8224 }
8225 breakpoints_changed ();
8226
8227 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8228 {
8229 if (from_tty)
8230 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8231 delete_breakpoint (b);
8232 }
8233 if (from_tty)
8234 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8235 }
8236 \f
8237 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8238 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8239 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8240
8241 void
8242 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8243 {
8244 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8245
8246 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8247 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8248 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8249 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8250 && bs->stop)
8251 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8252
8253 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8254 {
8255 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8256 delete_breakpoint (b);
8257 }
8258 }
8259
8260 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8261 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8262 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8263 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8264 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8265
8266 static int
8267 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8268 {
8269 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8270 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8271 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8272 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8273
8274 if (a->address != b->address)
8275 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8276
8277 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8278 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8279 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8280
8281 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8282 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8283
8284 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8285 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8286 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8287
8288 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8289 }
8290
8291 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8292 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8293 the bp_location array. */
8294
8295 static void
8296 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8297 {
8298 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8299
8300 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8301 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8302
8303 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8304 {
8305 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8306
8307 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8308 continue;
8309
8310 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8311 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8312
8313 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8314 addr = bl->address - start;
8315 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8316 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8317
8318 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8319
8320 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8321 addr = end - bl->address;
8322 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8323 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8324 }
8325 }
8326
8327 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8328 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8329 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8330 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8331 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8332 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8333 returns true on them.
8334
8335 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8336 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8337 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8338 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8339 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8340 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8341
8342 static void
8343 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8344 {
8345 struct breakpoint *b;
8346 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8347 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8348
8349 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8350 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8351 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8352 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8353 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8354 once. */
8355 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8356 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8357 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8358 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8359
8360 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8361 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8362 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8363 unsigned old_location_count;
8364
8365 old_location = bp_location;
8366 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8367 bp_location = NULL;
8368 bp_location_count = 0;
8369 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8370
8371 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8372 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8373 bp_location_count++;
8374
8375 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8376 locp = bp_location;
8377 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8378 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8379 *locp++ = loc;
8380 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8381 bp_location_compare);
8382
8383 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8384
8385 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8386 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8387 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8388 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8389 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8390
8391 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8392 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8393
8394 locp = bp_location;
8395 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8396 old_locp++)
8397 {
8398 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8399 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8400
8401 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8402 have to free it. */
8403 int found_object = 0;
8404 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8405 int keep_in_target = 0;
8406 int removed = 0;
8407
8408 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8409 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8410 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8411 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8412 locp++;
8413
8414 for (loc2p = locp;
8415 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8416 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8417 loc2p++)
8418 {
8419 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8420 {
8421 found_object = 1;
8422 break;
8423 }
8424 }
8425
8426 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8427 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8428 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8429 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8430 inserted. */
8431
8432 if (old_loc->inserted)
8433 {
8434 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8435
8436 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8437 {
8438 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8439 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8440 keep_in_target = 1;
8441 }
8442 else
8443 {
8444 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8445 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8446 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8447
8448 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8449 {
8450 for (loc2p = locp;
8451 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8452 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8453 loc2p++)
8454 {
8455 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8456
8457 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8458 {
8459 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8460 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8461 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8462 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8463 {
8464 loc2->inserted = 1;
8465 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8466 keep_in_target = 1;
8467 break;
8468 }
8469 }
8470 }
8471 }
8472 }
8473
8474 if (!keep_in_target)
8475 {
8476 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8477 {
8478 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8479 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8480 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8481 succeed next time.
8482
8483 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8484 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8485 after calling us. */
8486 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8487 old_loc->owner->number);
8488 }
8489 removed = 1;
8490 }
8491 }
8492
8493 if (!found_object)
8494 {
8495 if (removed && non_stop
8496 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8497 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8498 {
8499 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8500 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8501 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8502 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8503 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8504 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8505 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8506 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8507 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8508 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8509 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8510 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8511 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8512 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8513 SIGTRAP.
8514
8515 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8516 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8517
8518 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8519 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8520 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8521 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8522 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8523 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8524 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8525 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8526 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8527 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8528 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8529 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8530 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8531 thread_count.
8532
8533 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8534 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8535 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8536 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8537
8538 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8539 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8540 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8541 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8542 traps we can no longer explain. */
8543
8544 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8545 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8546
8547 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8548 }
8549 else
8550 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8551 }
8552 }
8553
8554 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8555 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8556 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8557 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8558 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8559 are sorted first for the same address.
8560
8561 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8562 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8563
8564 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8565 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8566 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8567 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8568 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8569 {
8570 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8571 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8572
8573 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8574 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8575 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8576 || !loc->enabled
8577 || loc->shlib_disabled
8578 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8579 || tracepoint_type (b))
8580 continue;
8581
8582 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8583 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8584 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8585 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8586 "actually inserted"));
8587
8588 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8589 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8590 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8591 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8592 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8593 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8594 else
8595 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8596
8597 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8598 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8599 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8600 {
8601 *loc_first_p = loc;
8602 loc->duplicate = 0;
8603 continue;
8604 }
8605
8606 loc->duplicate = 1;
8607
8608 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8609 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8610 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8611 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8612 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8613 }
8614
8615 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8616 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8617 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8618 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8619
8620 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8621 }
8622
8623 void
8624 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8625 {
8626 struct bp_location *loc;
8627 int ix;
8628
8629 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8630 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8631 {
8632 free_bp_location (loc);
8633 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8634 --ix;
8635 }
8636 }
8637
8638 static void
8639 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8640 {
8641 struct gdb_exception e;
8642 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8643 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8644 }
8645
8646 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8647 static void
8648 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8649 {
8650 bpstat bs;
8651 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8652 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8653 {
8654 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8655 bs->old_val = NULL;
8656 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8657 }
8658 }
8659
8660 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8661 static int
8662 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8663 {
8664 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8665 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8666 return 0;
8667 }
8668
8669 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8670 structures. */
8671
8672 void
8673 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8674 {
8675 struct breakpoint *b;
8676 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8677
8678 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8679
8680 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8681 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8682
8683 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8684 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8685 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8686 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8687 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8688
8689 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8690 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8691 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8692 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8693 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8694 return;
8695
8696 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
8697 breakpoints gets resolved. */
8698 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
8699 {
8700 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
8701 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
8702 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8703 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8704 }
8705
8706 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8707
8708 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8709 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8710
8711 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8712 if (b->next == bpt)
8713 {
8714 b->next = bpt->next;
8715 break;
8716 }
8717
8718 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8719 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8720 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8721 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8722 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8723 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8724 xfree (bpt->exp);
8725 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8726 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8727 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8728 value_free (bpt->val);
8729 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8730 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8731 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8732 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8733 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8734
8735 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8736 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8737 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8738 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8739 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8740 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8741 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8742 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8743 with commands won't work. */
8744
8745 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8746
8747 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8748 list, update the global location list. This
8749 will remove locations that used to belong to
8750 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8751 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8752 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8753 design to have location completely self-contained,
8754 but it's not the case now. */
8755 update_global_location_list (0);
8756
8757
8758 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8759 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8760 bpt->type = bp_none;
8761
8762 xfree (bpt);
8763 }
8764
8765 static void
8766 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8767 {
8768 delete_breakpoint (b);
8769 }
8770
8771 struct cleanup *
8772 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8773 {
8774 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8775 }
8776
8777 void
8778 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8779 {
8780 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8781
8782 dont_repeat ();
8783
8784 if (arg == 0)
8785 {
8786 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8787
8788 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8789 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8790 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8791 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8792 {
8793 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8794 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8795 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8796 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8797 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8798 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8799 && b->number >= 0)
8800 {
8801 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8802 break;
8803 }
8804 }
8805
8806 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8807 if (!from_tty
8808 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8809 {
8810 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8811 {
8812 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8813 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8814 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8815 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8816 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8817 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8818 && b->number >= 0)
8819 delete_breakpoint (b);
8820 }
8821 }
8822 }
8823 else
8824 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8825 }
8826
8827 static int
8828 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8829 {
8830 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8831 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8832 return 0;
8833 return 1;
8834 }
8835
8836 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8837 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8838 Null names are ignored. */
8839
8840 static int
8841 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8842 {
8843 struct bp_location *l;
8844 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8845 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8846 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8847
8848 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8849 {
8850 const char **slot;
8851 const char *name = l->function_name;
8852
8853 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8854 if (name == NULL)
8855 continue;
8856
8857 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8858 INSERT);
8859 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8860 NULL. */
8861 if (*slot != NULL)
8862 {
8863 htab_delete (htab);
8864 return 1;
8865 }
8866 *slot = name;
8867 }
8868
8869 htab_delete (htab);
8870 return 0;
8871 }
8872
8873 static void
8874 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8875 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8876 {
8877 int i;
8878 char *s;
8879 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8880
8881 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8882 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
8883 the common case where all locations are in the same
8884 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8885 retain the location, so that when the library
8886 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8887 status of the individual locations. */
8888 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8889 return;
8890
8891 b->loc = NULL;
8892
8893 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8894 {
8895 struct bp_location *new_loc =
8896 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8897
8898 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8899 old symtab. */
8900 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8901 {
8902 struct gdb_exception e;
8903
8904 s = b->cond_string;
8905 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8906 {
8907 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8908 0);
8909 }
8910 if (e.reason < 0)
8911 {
8912 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8913 b->number, e.message);
8914 new_loc->enabled = 0;
8915 }
8916 }
8917
8918 if (b->source_file != NULL)
8919 xfree (b->source_file);
8920 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8921 b->source_file = NULL;
8922 else
8923 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8924
8925 if (b->line_number == 0)
8926 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8927 }
8928
8929 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
8930 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8931 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8932
8933 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
8934 {
8935 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8936 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8937 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8938 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8939 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8940 often enough until a better solution is found. */
8941 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8942
8943 for (; e; e = e->next)
8944 {
8945 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8946 {
8947 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8948 if (have_ambiguous_names)
8949 {
8950 for (; l; l = l->next)
8951 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8952 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8953 {
8954 l->enabled = 0;
8955 break;
8956 }
8957 }
8958 else
8959 {
8960 for (; l; l = l->next)
8961 if (l->function_name
8962 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8963 {
8964 l->enabled = 0;
8965 break;
8966 }
8967 }
8968 }
8969 }
8970 }
8971
8972 update_global_location_list (1);
8973 }
8974
8975
8976 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8977 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8978 Unused in this case. */
8979
8980 static int
8981 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8982 {
8983 /* get past catch_errs */
8984 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8985 struct value *mark;
8986 int i;
8987 int not_found = 0;
8988 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8989 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8990 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8991 char *s;
8992 enum enable_state save_enable;
8993 struct gdb_exception e;
8994 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8995
8996 switch (b->type)
8997 {
8998 case bp_none:
8999 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9000 b->number);
9001 return 0;
9002 case bp_breakpoint:
9003 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9004 case bp_tracepoint:
9005 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9006 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
9007 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9008 return 0;
9009
9010 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9011 {
9012 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9013 delete_breakpoint (b);
9014 return 0;
9015 }
9016
9017 set_language (b->language);
9018 input_radix = b->input_radix;
9019 s = b->addr_string;
9020
9021 save_current_space_and_thread ();
9022 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9023
9024 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9025 {
9026 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9027 not_found_ptr);
9028 }
9029 if (e.reason < 0)
9030 {
9031 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9032 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9033 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9034 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9035 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9036 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9037 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
9038 if (not_found
9039 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9040 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9041 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9042 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9043
9044 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9045 {
9046 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9047 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9048 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9049 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9050 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9051 which approach is better. */
9052 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9053 throw_exception (e);
9054 }
9055 }
9056
9057 if (!not_found)
9058 {
9059 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9060
9061 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9062 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9063 {
9064 char *cond_string = 0;
9065 int thread = -1;
9066 int task = 0;
9067
9068 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9069 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9070 if (cond_string)
9071 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9072 b->thread = thread;
9073 b->task = task;
9074 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9075 }
9076
9077 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9078 }
9079
9080 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9081 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9082 break;
9083
9084 case bp_watchpoint:
9085 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9086 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9087 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9088 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9089 or it can be on local variables.
9090
9091 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9092 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9093 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9094 and unloaded.
9095
9096 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9097 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9098 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9099 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9100 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9101 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9102
9103 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9104 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9105 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9106 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9107
9108 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9109 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9110
9111 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9112 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9113 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9114 break;
9115 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9116 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9117 loaded. */
9118 case bp_catchpoint:
9119 break;
9120
9121 default:
9122 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9123 /* fall through */
9124 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9125 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9126 case bp_overlay_event:
9127 case bp_longjmp_master:
9128 delete_breakpoint (b);
9129 break;
9130
9131 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9132 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9133 case bp_shlib_event:
9134
9135 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9136 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9137 case bp_thread_event:
9138
9139 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9140 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9141 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9142 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9143 case bp_until:
9144 case bp_finish:
9145 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9146 case bp_call_dummy:
9147 case bp_step_resume:
9148 case bp_longjmp:
9149 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9150 case bp_jit_event:
9151 break;
9152 }
9153
9154 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9155 return 0;
9156 }
9157
9158 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9159 void
9160 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9161 {
9162 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9163 enum language save_language;
9164 int save_input_radix;
9165 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9166
9167 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9168 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9169 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9170
9171 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9172 {
9173 /* Format possible error msg */
9174 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9175 b->number);
9176 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9177 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9178 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9179 }
9180 set_language (save_language);
9181 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9182
9183 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9184
9185 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9186
9187 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9188 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9189 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9190 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9191 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9192 }
9193 \f
9194 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9195
9196 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9197 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9198 void
9199 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9200 {
9201 if (b->thread != -1)
9202 {
9203 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9204 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9205
9206 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9207 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9208 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9209 as well. */
9210 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9211 }
9212 }
9213
9214 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9215 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9216 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9217
9218 void
9219 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9220 {
9221 struct breakpoint *b;
9222
9223 if (count < 0)
9224 count = 0;
9225
9226 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9227 if (b->number == bptnum)
9228 {
9229 b->ignore_count = count;
9230 if (from_tty)
9231 {
9232 if (count == 0)
9233 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9234 bptnum);
9235 else if (count == 1)
9236 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9237 bptnum);
9238 else
9239 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9240 count, bptnum);
9241 }
9242 breakpoints_changed ();
9243 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9244 return;
9245 }
9246
9247 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9248 }
9249
9250 void
9251 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9252 {
9253 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9254 b->silent = 1;
9255 }
9256
9257 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9258
9259 static void
9260 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9261 {
9262 char *p = args;
9263 int num;
9264
9265 if (p == 0)
9266 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9267
9268 num = get_number (&p);
9269 if (num == 0)
9270 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9271 if (*p == 0)
9272 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9273
9274 set_ignore_count (num,
9275 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9276 from_tty);
9277 if (from_tty)
9278 printf_filtered ("\n");
9279 }
9280 \f
9281 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9282 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9283
9284 static void
9285 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9286 {
9287 char *p = args;
9288 char *p1;
9289 int num;
9290 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9291 int match;
9292
9293 if (p == 0)
9294 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9295
9296 while (*p)
9297 {
9298 match = 0;
9299 p1 = p;
9300
9301 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9302 if (num == 0)
9303 {
9304 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9305 }
9306 else
9307 {
9308 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9309 if (b->number == num)
9310 {
9311 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9312 match = 1;
9313 function (b);
9314 if (related_breakpoint)
9315 function (related_breakpoint);
9316 break;
9317 }
9318 if (match == 0)
9319 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9320 }
9321 p = p1;
9322 }
9323 }
9324
9325 static struct bp_location *
9326 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9327 {
9328 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9329 char *p1;
9330 int bp_num;
9331 int loc_num;
9332 struct breakpoint *b;
9333 struct bp_location *loc;
9334
9335 *dot = '\0';
9336
9337 p1 = number;
9338 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9339 if (bp_num == 0)
9340 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9341
9342 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9343 if (b->number == bp_num)
9344 {
9345 break;
9346 }
9347
9348 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9349 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9350
9351 p1 = dot+1;
9352 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9353 if (loc_num == 0)
9354 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9355
9356 --loc_num;
9357 loc = b->loc;
9358 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9359 ;
9360 if (!loc)
9361 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9362
9363 return loc;
9364 }
9365
9366
9367 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9368 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9369 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9370
9371 void
9372 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9373 {
9374 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9375 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9376 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9377 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9378 return;
9379
9380 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9381 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9382 return;
9383
9384 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9385
9386 update_global_location_list (0);
9387
9388 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9389 }
9390
9391 static void
9392 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9393 {
9394 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9395 if (args == 0)
9396 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9397 switch (bpt->type)
9398 {
9399 case bp_none:
9400 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9401 bpt->number);
9402 continue;
9403 case bp_breakpoint:
9404 case bp_tracepoint:
9405 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9406 case bp_catchpoint:
9407 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9408 case bp_watchpoint:
9409 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9410 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9411 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9412 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9413 default:
9414 continue;
9415 }
9416 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9417 {
9418 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9419 if (loc)
9420 loc->enabled = 0;
9421 update_global_location_list (0);
9422 }
9423 else
9424 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9425 }
9426
9427 static void
9428 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9429 {
9430 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9431 struct value *mark;
9432
9433 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9434 {
9435 int i;
9436 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9437 target_resources_ok =
9438 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9439 i + 1, 0);
9440 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9441 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9442 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9443 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9444 }
9445
9446 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9447 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9448 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9449 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9450 {
9451 struct gdb_exception e;
9452
9453 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9454 {
9455 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9456 }
9457 if (e.reason < 0)
9458 {
9459 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9460 bpt->number);
9461 return;
9462 }
9463 }
9464
9465 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9466 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9467 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9468 update_global_location_list (1);
9469 breakpoints_changed ();
9470
9471 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9472 }
9473
9474
9475 void
9476 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9477 {
9478 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9479 }
9480
9481 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9482 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9483 in stopping the inferior. */
9484
9485 static void
9486 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9487 {
9488 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9489 if (args == 0)
9490 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9491 switch (bpt->type)
9492 {
9493 case bp_none:
9494 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9495 bpt->number);
9496 continue;
9497 case bp_breakpoint:
9498 case bp_tracepoint:
9499 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9500 case bp_catchpoint:
9501 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9502 case bp_watchpoint:
9503 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9504 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9505 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9506 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9507 default:
9508 continue;
9509 }
9510 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9511 {
9512 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9513 if (loc)
9514 loc->enabled = 1;
9515 update_global_location_list (1);
9516 }
9517 else
9518 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9519 }
9520
9521 static void
9522 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9523 {
9524 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9525 }
9526
9527 static void
9528 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9529 {
9530 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9531 }
9532
9533 static void
9534 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9535 {
9536 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9537 }
9538
9539 static void
9540 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9541 {
9542 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9543 }
9544 \f
9545 static void
9546 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9547 {
9548 }
9549
9550 static void
9551 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9552 {
9553 }
9554
9555 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9556 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9557 GDB itself. */
9558
9559 static void
9560 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9561 const bfd_byte *data)
9562 {
9563 struct breakpoint *bp;
9564
9565 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9566 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9567 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9568 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9569 {
9570 struct bp_location *loc;
9571
9572 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9573 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9574 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9575 && addr + len > loc->address)
9576 {
9577 value_free (bp->val);
9578 bp->val = NULL;
9579 bp->val_valid = 0;
9580 }
9581 }
9582 }
9583
9584 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9585
9586 struct symtabs_and_lines
9587 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9588 {
9589 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9590 if (string == 0)
9591 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9592 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9593 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9594 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9595 default_breakpoint_line,
9596 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9597 else
9598 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9599 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9600 if (*string)
9601 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9602 return sals;
9603 }
9604
9605 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9606 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9607 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9608 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9609 someday. */
9610
9611 void *
9612 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9613 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9614 {
9615 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9616
9617 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9618
9619 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9620 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9621
9622 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9623 {
9624 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9625 xfree (bp_tgt);
9626 return NULL;
9627 }
9628
9629 return bp_tgt;
9630 }
9631
9632 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9633
9634 int
9635 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9636 {
9637 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9638 int ret;
9639
9640 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9641 xfree (bp_tgt);
9642
9643 return ret;
9644 }
9645
9646 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9647
9648 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9649 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9650
9651 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9652
9653 void
9654 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9655 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9656 {
9657 void **bpt_p;
9658
9659 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9660 {
9661 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9662 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9663 }
9664 else
9665 {
9666 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9667 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9668 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9669 }
9670
9671 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9672 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9673 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9674 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9675 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9676 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9677
9678 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9679 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9680 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9681 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9682 }
9683
9684 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9685
9686 void
9687 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9688 {
9689 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9690
9691 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9692 call. */
9693 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9694 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9695 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9696 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9697
9698 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9699 {
9700 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9701 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9702 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9703 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9704 }
9705 }
9706
9707 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9708
9709 static int
9710 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9711 {
9712 int i;
9713
9714 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9715 {
9716 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9717 if (bp_tgt
9718 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9719 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9720 aspace, pc))
9721 return 1;
9722 }
9723
9724 return 0;
9725 }
9726
9727 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9728 non-zero otherwise. */
9729 static int
9730 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9731 {
9732 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9733 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9734 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9735 return 1;
9736 else
9737 return 0;
9738 }
9739
9740 int
9741 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9742 {
9743 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9744
9745 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9746 }
9747
9748 int
9749 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9750 {
9751 struct breakpoint *bp;
9752
9753 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9754 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9755 {
9756 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9757 {
9758 int i, iter;
9759 for (i = 0;
9760 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9761 i++)
9762 if (syscall_number == iter)
9763 return 1;
9764 }
9765 else
9766 return 1;
9767 }
9768
9769 return 0;
9770 }
9771
9772 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9773 static char **
9774 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9775 char *text, char *word)
9776 {
9777 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9778 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9779 }
9780
9781 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9782
9783 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9784 static void
9785 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9786 {
9787 tracepoint_count = num;
9788 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9789 }
9790
9791 void
9792 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9793 {
9794 if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9795 arg,
9796 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9797 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9798 1 /* traceflag */,
9799 0 /* Ignore count */,
9800 pending_break_support,
9801 NULL,
9802 from_tty,
9803 1 /* enabled */))
9804 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9805 }
9806
9807 void
9808 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9809 {
9810 if (break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9811 arg,
9812 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9813 0 /* tempflag */, 1 /* hardwareflag */,
9814 1 /* traceflag */,
9815 0 /* Ignore count */,
9816 pending_break_support,
9817 NULL,
9818 from_tty,
9819 1 /* enabled */))
9820 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9821 }
9822
9823 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
9824 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
9825 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
9826 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
9827 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
9828
9829 struct breakpoint *
9830 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
9831 {
9832 char buf[100];
9833 struct breakpoint *tp;
9834
9835 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address. */
9836 sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
9837
9838 if (!break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9839 buf,
9840 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9841 0 /* tempflag */,
9842 (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
9843 1 /* traceflag */,
9844 0 /* Ignore count */,
9845 pending_break_support,
9846 NULL,
9847 0 /* from_tty */,
9848 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
9849 return NULL;
9850
9851 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9852
9853 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
9854 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
9855
9856 if (utp->pass > 0)
9857 {
9858 sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
9859
9860 trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
9861 }
9862
9863 if (utp->cond)
9864 {
9865 printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
9866 }
9867
9868 if (utp->numactions > 0)
9869 {
9870 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
9871 }
9872
9873 if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
9874 {
9875 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
9876 }
9877
9878 return tp;
9879 }
9880
9881 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9882 omitted. */
9883
9884 static void
9885 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9886 {
9887 struct breakpoint *b;
9888 int tps_to_list = 0;
9889
9890 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
9891 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9892 {
9893 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9894 {
9895 if (b->number >= 0)
9896 {
9897 tps_to_list = 1;
9898 break;
9899 }
9900 }
9901 if (!tps_to_list)
9902 {
9903 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9904 return;
9905 }
9906 }
9907
9908 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
9909 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9910 }
9911
9912 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9913 Not supported by all targets. */
9914 static void
9915 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9916 {
9917 enable_command (args, from_tty);
9918 }
9919
9920 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9921 Not supported by all targets. */
9922 static void
9923 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9924 {
9925 disable_command (args, from_tty);
9926 }
9927
9928 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9929 static void
9930 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9931 {
9932 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9933
9934 dont_repeat ();
9935
9936 if (arg == 0)
9937 {
9938 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9939
9940 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9941 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9942 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9943 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9944 {
9945 if (b->number >= 0)
9946 {
9947 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9948 break;
9949 }
9950 }
9951
9952 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9953 if (!from_tty
9954 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9955 {
9956 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9957 {
9958 if (tracepoint_type (b)
9959 && b->number >= 0)
9960 delete_breakpoint (b);
9961 }
9962 }
9963 }
9964 else
9965 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9966 }
9967
9968 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9969
9970 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9971 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9972 Also accepts special argument "all". */
9973
9974 static void
9975 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9976 {
9977 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9978 unsigned int count;
9979 int all = 0;
9980
9981 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9982 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9983
9984 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9985
9986 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9987 args++;
9988
9989 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9990 {
9991 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
9992 all = 1;
9993 if (*args)
9994 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9995 }
9996 else
9997 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9998
9999 do
10000 {
10001 if (t1)
10002 {
10003 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10004 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10005 {
10006 t2->pass_count = count;
10007 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10008 if (from_tty)
10009 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10010 t2->number, count);
10011 }
10012 if (! all && *args)
10013 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10014 }
10015 }
10016 while (*args);
10017 }
10018
10019 struct breakpoint *
10020 get_tracepoint (int num)
10021 {
10022 struct breakpoint *t;
10023
10024 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10025 if (t->number == num)
10026 return t;
10027
10028 return NULL;
10029 }
10030
10031 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10032 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10033 reconnecting). */
10034
10035 struct breakpoint *
10036 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10037 {
10038 struct breakpoint *t;
10039
10040 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10041 if (t->number_on_target == num)
10042 return t;
10043
10044 return NULL;
10045 }
10046
10047 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10048 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10049 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10050 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
10051 struct breakpoint *
10052 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10053 {
10054 extern int tracepoint_count;
10055 struct breakpoint *t;
10056 int tpnum;
10057 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10058
10059 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10060 {
10061 if (optional_p)
10062 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10063 else
10064 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10065 }
10066 else
10067 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10068
10069 if (tpnum <= 0)
10070 {
10071 if (instring && *instring)
10072 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10073 instring);
10074 else
10075 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10076 return NULL;
10077 }
10078
10079 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10080 if (t->number == tpnum)
10081 {
10082 return t;
10083 }
10084
10085 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10086 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10087 allow us to discover this. */
10088 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10089 return NULL;
10090 }
10091
10092 /* save-tracepoints command */
10093 static void
10094 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10095 {
10096 struct breakpoint *tp;
10097 int any_tp = 0;
10098 struct action_line *line;
10099 FILE *fp;
10100 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
10101 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
10102 char tmp[40];
10103 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10104
10105 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10106 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10107
10108 /* See if we have anything to save. */
10109 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10110 {
10111 any_tp = 1;
10112 break;
10113 }
10114 if (!any_tp)
10115 {
10116 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10117 return;
10118 }
10119
10120 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10121 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10122 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
10123 if (!fp)
10124 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10125 args, safe_strerror (errno));
10126 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
10127
10128 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10129 {
10130 if (tp->addr_string)
10131 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10132 else
10133 {
10134 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10135 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10136 }
10137
10138 if (tp->pass_count)
10139 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10140
10141 if (tp->actions)
10142 {
10143 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10144 indent = i1;
10145 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10146 {
10147 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10148
10149 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10150 actionline = line->action;
10151 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10152 actionline++;
10153
10154 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10155 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10156 {
10157 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10158 if (cmd == 0)
10159 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10160 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10161 indent = i2;
10162 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10163 indent = i1;
10164 }
10165 }
10166 }
10167 }
10168 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10169 if (from_tty)
10170 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10171 return;
10172 }
10173
10174 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10175
10176 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10177 all_tracepoints ()
10178 {
10179 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10180 struct breakpoint *tp;
10181
10182 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10183 {
10184 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10185 }
10186
10187 return tp_vec;
10188 }
10189
10190 \f
10191 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10192 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10193 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10194 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10195 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10196 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10197 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10198 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10199 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10200 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10201 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10202 \n\
10203 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10204 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10205 \n\
10206 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10207 \n\
10208 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10209
10210 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10211 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10212
10213 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10214 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10215
10216 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10217 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10218 static void
10219 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10220 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10221 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10222 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10223 char *text, char *word),
10224 void *user_data_catch,
10225 void *user_data_tcatch)
10226 {
10227 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10228
10229 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10230 &catch_cmdlist);
10231 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10232 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10233 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10234
10235 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10236 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10237 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10238 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10239 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10240 }
10241
10242 static void
10243 clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10244 {
10245 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10246
10247 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10248 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10249 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10250 }
10251
10252 void
10253 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10254 {
10255 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10256 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10257 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10258
10259 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10260 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10261 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10262
10263 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10264 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10265 before a breakpoint is set. */
10266 breakpoint_count = 0;
10267
10268 tracepoint_count = 0;
10269
10270 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10271 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10272 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10273 if (xdb_commands)
10274 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10275
10276 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10277 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10278 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10279 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10280 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10281 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10282 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10283 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10284
10285 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10286 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10287 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10288 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10289
10290 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10291 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10292 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10293 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10294 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10295 \n"
10296 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10297 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10298
10299 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10300 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10301 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10302 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10303 \n"
10304 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10305 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10306
10307 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10308 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10309 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10310 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10311 \n"
10312 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10313 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10314
10315 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10316 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10317 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10318 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10319 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10320 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10321 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10322 if (xdb_commands)
10323 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10324 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10325 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10326 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10327 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10328 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10329
10330 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10331
10332 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10333 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10334 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10335 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10336 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10337 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10338
10339 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10340 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10341 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10342 &enablebreaklist);
10343
10344 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10345 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10346 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10347 &enablebreaklist);
10348
10349 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10350 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10351 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10352 &enablelist);
10353
10354 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10355 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10356 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10357 &enablelist);
10358
10359 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10360 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10361 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10362 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10363 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10364 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10365 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10366 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10367 if (xdb_commands)
10368 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10369 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10370 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10371 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10372 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10373
10374 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10375 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10376 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10377 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10378 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10379 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10380 &disablelist);
10381
10382 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10383 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10384 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10385 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10386 \n\
10387 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10388 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10389 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10390 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10391 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10392 if (xdb_commands)
10393 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10394 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10395 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10396 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10397
10398 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10399 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10400 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10401 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10402 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10403 &deletelist);
10404
10405 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10406 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10407 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10408 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10409 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10410 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10411 \n\
10412 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10413 is executing in.\n\
10414 \n\
10415 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10416
10417 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10418 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10419 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10420 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10421
10422 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10423 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10424 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10425 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10426
10427 if (xdb_commands)
10428 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10429
10430 if (dbx_commands)
10431 {
10432 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10433 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10434 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10435 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10436 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10437 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10438 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10439 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10440 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10441 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10442 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10443 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10444 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10445 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10446 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10447 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10448 \n\
10449 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10450 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10451 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10452 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10453 breakpoint set."));
10454 }
10455
10456 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10457 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10458 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10459 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10460 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10461 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10462 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10463 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10464 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10465 \n\
10466 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10467 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10468 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10469 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10470 breakpoint set."));
10471
10472 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10473
10474 if (xdb_commands)
10475 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10476 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10477 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10478 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10479 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10480 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10481 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10482 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10483 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10484 \n\
10485 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10486 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10487 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10488 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10489 breakpoint set."));
10490
10491 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10492 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10493 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10494 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10495 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10496 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10497 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10498 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10499 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10500 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10501 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10502 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10503 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10504 \n\
10505 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10506 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10507 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10508 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10509 breakpoint set."),
10510 &maintenanceinfolist);
10511
10512 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10513 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10514 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10515 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10516
10517 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10518 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10519 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10520 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10521
10522 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10523 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10524 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10525 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10526 catch_catch_command,
10527 NULL,
10528 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10529 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10530 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10531 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10532 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10533 catch_throw_command,
10534 NULL,
10535 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10536 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10537 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10538 catch_fork_command_1,
10539 NULL,
10540 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10541 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10542 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10543 catch_fork_command_1,
10544 NULL,
10545 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10546 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10547 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10548 catch_exec_command_1,
10549 NULL,
10550 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10551 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10552 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10553 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10554 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10555 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10556 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10557 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10558 catch_syscall_command_1,
10559 catch_syscall_completer,
10560 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10561 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10562 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10563 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10564 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10565 catch_ada_exception_command,
10566 NULL,
10567 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10568 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10569 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10570 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10571 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10572 catch_assert_command,
10573 NULL,
10574 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10575 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10576
10577 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10578 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10579 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10580 an expression changes."));
10581 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10582
10583 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10584 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10585 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10586 an expression is read."));
10587 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10588
10589 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10590 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10591 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10592 an expression is either read or written."));
10593 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10594
10595 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10596 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10597
10598
10599 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10600 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10601 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10602 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10603 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10604 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10605 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10606 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10607 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10608 hardware.)"),
10609 NULL,
10610 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10611 &setlist, &showlist);
10612
10613 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10614
10615 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10616
10617 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10618 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10619 \n"
10620 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10621 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10622 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10623
10624 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10625 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10626 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10627 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10628
10629 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10630 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10631 \n"
10632 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10633 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10634 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10635
10636 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10637 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10638 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10639 last tracepoint set."));
10640
10641 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10642
10643 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10644 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10645 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10646 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10647 &deletelist);
10648
10649 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10650 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10651 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10652 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10653 &disablelist);
10654 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10655
10656 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10657 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10658 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10659 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10660 &enablelist);
10661 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10662
10663 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10664 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10665 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10666 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10667 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10668
10669 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10670 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10671 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10672 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10673
10674 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10675 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10676 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10677 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10678 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10679 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10680 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10681 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10682 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10683 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10684 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10685 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10686
10687 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10688 &pending_break_support, _("\
10689 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10690 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10691 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10692 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10693 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10694 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10695 NULL,
10696 show_pending_break_support,
10697 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10698 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10699
10700 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10701
10702 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10703 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10704 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10705 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10706 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10707 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10708 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10709 NULL,
10710 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10711 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10712 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10713
10714 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10715 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10716 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10717 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10718 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10719 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10720 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10721 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10722 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10723 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10724 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10725 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10726 NULL,
10727 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10728 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10729 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10730
10731 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10732
10733 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10734 }